virtualx-engine/thirdparty/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c
Rémi Verschelde e289cf7085
pcre2: Update to upstream version 10.42 (take two)
Changelog: https://github.com/PCRE2Project/pcre2/blob/pcre2-10.42/ChangeLog

This fixes support for RISC-V architectures in the sljit library, so we
enable the module's compilation for `rv64` too.
2023-06-12 15:12:15 +02:00

10631 lines
345 KiB
C

/*************************************************
* Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions *
*************************************************/
/* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax
and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language.
Written by Philip Hazel
Original API code Copyright (c) 1997-2012 University of Cambridge
New API code Copyright (c) 2016-2022 University of Cambridge
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS"
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
*/
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
#include "config.h"
#endif
#define NLBLOCK cb /* Block containing newline information */
#define PSSTART start_pattern /* Field containing processed string start */
#define PSEND end_pattern /* Field containing processed string end */
#include "pcre2_internal.h"
/* In rare error cases debugging might require calling pcre2_printint(). */
#if 0
#ifdef EBCDIC
#define PRINTABLE(c) ((c) >= 64 && (c) < 255)
#else
#define PRINTABLE(c) ((c) >= 32 && (c) < 127)
#endif
#include "pcre2_printint.c"
#define DEBUG_CALL_PRINTINT
#endif
/* Other debugging code can be enabled by these defines. */
/* #define DEBUG_SHOW_CAPTURES */
/* #define DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED */
/* There are a few things that vary with different code unit sizes. Handle them
by defining macros in order to minimize #if usage. */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5
#define XDIGIT(c) xdigitab[c]
#else /* Either 16-bit or 32-bit */
#define XDIGIT(c) (MAX_255(c)? xdigitab[c] : 0xff)
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6
#else /* 32-bit */
#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6
#endif
#endif
/* Macros to store and retrieve a PCRE2_SIZE value in the parsed pattern, which
consists of uint32_t elements. Assume that if uint32_t can't hold it, two of
them will be able to (i.e. assume a 64-bit world). */
#if PCRE2_SIZE_MAX <= UINT32_MAX
#define PUTOFFSET(s,p) *p++ = s
#define GETOFFSET(s,p) s = *p++
#define GETPLUSOFFSET(s,p) s = *(++p)
#define READPLUSOFFSET(s,p) s = p[1]
#define SKIPOFFSET(p) p++
#define SIZEOFFSET 1
#else
#define PUTOFFSET(s,p) \
{ *p++ = (uint32_t)(s >> 32); *p++ = (uint32_t)(s & 0xffffffff); }
#define GETOFFSET(s,p) \
{ s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[0] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[1]; p += 2; }
#define GETPLUSOFFSET(s,p) \
{ s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[1] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[2]; p += 2; }
#define READPLUSOFFSET(s,p) \
{ s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[1] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[2]; }
#define SKIPOFFSET(p) p += 2
#define SIZEOFFSET 2
#endif
/* Macros for manipulating elements of the parsed pattern vector. */
#define META_CODE(x) (x & 0xffff0000u)
#define META_DATA(x) (x & 0x0000ffffu)
#define META_DIFF(x,y) ((x-y)>>16)
/* Function definitions to allow mutual recursion */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
static unsigned int
add_list_to_class_internal(uint8_t *, PCRE2_UCHAR **, uint32_t,
compile_block *, const uint32_t *, unsigned int);
#endif
static int
compile_regex(uint32_t, PCRE2_UCHAR **, uint32_t **, int *, uint32_t,
uint32_t *, uint32_t *, uint32_t *, uint32_t *, branch_chain *,
compile_block *, PCRE2_SIZE *);
static int
get_branchlength(uint32_t **, int *, int *, parsed_recurse_check *,
compile_block *);
static BOOL
set_lookbehind_lengths(uint32_t **, int *, int *, parsed_recurse_check *,
compile_block *);
static int
check_lookbehinds(uint32_t *, uint32_t **, parsed_recurse_check *,
compile_block *, int *);
/*************************************************
* Code parameters and static tables *
*************************************************/
#define MAX_GROUP_NUMBER 65535u
#define MAX_REPEAT_COUNT 65535u
#define REPEAT_UNLIMITED (MAX_REPEAT_COUNT+1)
/* COMPILE_WORK_SIZE specifies the size of stack workspace, which is used in
different ways in the different pattern scans. The parsing and group-
identifying pre-scan uses it to handle nesting, and needs it to be 16-bit
aligned for this. Having defined the size in code units, we set up
C16_WORK_SIZE as the number of elements in the 16-bit vector.
During the first compiling phase, when determining how much memory is required,
the regex is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are
discarded as soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an
overrun. The code does, however, check for an overrun, which can occur for
pathological patterns. The size of the workspace depends on LINK_SIZE because
the length of compiled items varies with this.
In the real compile phase, this workspace is not currently used. */
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (3000*LINK_SIZE) /* Size in code units */
#define C16_WORK_SIZE \
((COMPILE_WORK_SIZE * sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR))/sizeof(uint16_t))
/* A uint32_t vector is used for caching information about the size of
capturing groups, to improve performance. A default is created on the stack of
this size. */
#define GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE 256
/* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the
overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */
#define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100)
/* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for
remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack,
but if it is too small, it is expanded, in a similar way to the workspace. The
value is the number of slots in the list. */
#define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE 20
/* The pre-compiling pass over the pattern creates a parsed pattern in a vector
of uint32_t. For short patterns this lives on the stack, with this size. Heap
memory is used for longer patterns. */
#define PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE 1024
/* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the variable
that holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less
than INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating code units, so that we
don't have to check them every time. */
#define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20)
/* Code values for parsed patterns, which are stored in a vector of 32-bit
unsigned ints. Values less than META_END are literal data values. The coding
for identifying the item is in the top 16-bits, leaving 16 bits for the
additional data that some of them need. The META_CODE, META_DATA, and META_DIFF
macros are used to manipulate parsed pattern elements.
NOTE: When these definitions are changed, the table of extra lengths for each
code (meta_extra_lengths, just below) must be updated to remain in step. */
#define META_END 0x80000000u /* End of pattern */
#define META_ALT 0x80010000u /* alternation */
#define META_ATOMIC 0x80020000u /* atomic group */
#define META_BACKREF 0x80030000u /* Back ref */
#define META_BACKREF_BYNAME 0x80040000u /* \k'name' */
#define META_BIGVALUE 0x80050000u /* Next is a literal > META_END */
#define META_CALLOUT_NUMBER 0x80060000u /* (?C with numerical argument */
#define META_CALLOUT_STRING 0x80070000u /* (?C with string argument */
#define META_CAPTURE 0x80080000u /* Capturing parenthesis */
#define META_CIRCUMFLEX 0x80090000u /* ^ metacharacter */
#define META_CLASS 0x800a0000u /* start non-empty class */
#define META_CLASS_EMPTY 0x800b0000u /* empty class */
#define META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT 0x800c0000u /* negative empty class */
#define META_CLASS_END 0x800d0000u /* end of non-empty class */
#define META_CLASS_NOT 0x800e0000u /* start non-empty negative class */
#define META_COND_ASSERT 0x800f0000u /* (?(?assertion)... */
#define META_COND_DEFINE 0x80100000u /* (?(DEFINE)... */
#define META_COND_NAME 0x80110000u /* (?(<name>)... */
#define META_COND_NUMBER 0x80120000u /* (?(digits)... */
#define META_COND_RNAME 0x80130000u /* (?(R&name)... */
#define META_COND_RNUMBER 0x80140000u /* (?(Rdigits)... */
#define META_COND_VERSION 0x80150000u /* (?(VERSION<op>x.y)... */
#define META_DOLLAR 0x80160000u /* $ metacharacter */
#define META_DOT 0x80170000u /* . metacharacter */
#define META_ESCAPE 0x80180000u /* \d and friends */
#define META_KET 0x80190000u /* closing parenthesis */
#define META_NOCAPTURE 0x801a0000u /* no capture parens */
#define META_OPTIONS 0x801b0000u /* (?i) and friends */
#define META_POSIX 0x801c0000u /* POSIX class item */
#define META_POSIX_NEG 0x801d0000u /* negative POSIX class item */
#define META_RANGE_ESCAPED 0x801e0000u /* range with at least one escape */
#define META_RANGE_LITERAL 0x801f0000u /* range defined literally */
#define META_RECURSE 0x80200000u /* Recursion */
#define META_RECURSE_BYNAME 0x80210000u /* (?&name) */
#define META_SCRIPT_RUN 0x80220000u /* (*script_run:...) */
/* These must be kept together to make it easy to check that an assertion
is present where expected in a conditional group. */
#define META_LOOKAHEAD 0x80230000u /* (?= */
#define META_LOOKAHEADNOT 0x80240000u /* (?! */
#define META_LOOKBEHIND 0x80250000u /* (?<= */
#define META_LOOKBEHINDNOT 0x80260000u /* (?<! */
/* These cannot be conditions */
#define META_LOOKAHEAD_NA 0x80270000u /* (*napla: */
#define META_LOOKBEHIND_NA 0x80280000u /* (*naplb: */
/* These must be kept in this order, with consecutive values, and the _ARG
versions of COMMIT, PRUNE, SKIP, and THEN immediately after their non-argument
versions. */
#define META_MARK 0x80290000u /* (*MARK) */
#define META_ACCEPT 0x802a0000u /* (*ACCEPT) */
#define META_FAIL 0x802b0000u /* (*FAIL) */
#define META_COMMIT 0x802c0000u /* These */
#define META_COMMIT_ARG 0x802d0000u /* pairs */
#define META_PRUNE 0x802e0000u /* must */
#define META_PRUNE_ARG 0x802f0000u /* be */
#define META_SKIP 0x80300000u /* kept */
#define META_SKIP_ARG 0x80310000u /* in */
#define META_THEN 0x80320000u /* this */
#define META_THEN_ARG 0x80330000u /* order */
/* These must be kept in groups of adjacent 3 values, and all together. */
#define META_ASTERISK 0x80340000u /* * */
#define META_ASTERISK_PLUS 0x80350000u /* *+ */
#define META_ASTERISK_QUERY 0x80360000u /* *? */
#define META_PLUS 0x80370000u /* + */
#define META_PLUS_PLUS 0x80380000u /* ++ */
#define META_PLUS_QUERY 0x80390000u /* +? */
#define META_QUERY 0x803a0000u /* ? */
#define META_QUERY_PLUS 0x803b0000u /* ?+ */
#define META_QUERY_QUERY 0x803c0000u /* ?? */
#define META_MINMAX 0x803d0000u /* {n,m} repeat */
#define META_MINMAX_PLUS 0x803e0000u /* {n,m}+ repeat */
#define META_MINMAX_QUERY 0x803f0000u /* {n,m}? repeat */
#define META_FIRST_QUANTIFIER META_ASTERISK
#define META_LAST_QUANTIFIER META_MINMAX_QUERY
/* This is a special "meta code" that is used only to distinguish (*asr: from
(*sr: in the table of aphabetic assertions. It is never stored in the parsed
pattern because (*asr: is turned into (*sr:(*atomic: at that stage. There is
therefore no need for it to have a length entry, so use a high value. */
#define META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN 0x8fff0000u
/* Table of extra lengths for each of the meta codes. Must be kept in step with
the definitions above. For some items these values are a basic length to which
a variable amount has to be added. */
static unsigned char meta_extra_lengths[] = {
0, /* META_END */
0, /* META_ALT */
0, /* META_ATOMIC */
0, /* META_BACKREF - more if group is >= 10 */
1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_BACKREF_BYNAME */
1, /* META_BIGVALUE */
3, /* META_CALLOUT_NUMBER */
3+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_CALLOUT_STRING */
0, /* META_CAPTURE */
0, /* META_CIRCUMFLEX */
0, /* META_CLASS */
0, /* META_CLASS_EMPTY */
0, /* META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT */
0, /* META_CLASS_END */
0, /* META_CLASS_NOT */
0, /* META_COND_ASSERT */
SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_DEFINE */
1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_NAME */
1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_NUMBER */
1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_RNAME */
1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_RNUMBER */
3, /* META_COND_VERSION */
0, /* META_DOLLAR */
0, /* META_DOT */
0, /* META_ESCAPE - more for ESC_P, ESC_p, ESC_g, ESC_k */
0, /* META_KET */
0, /* META_NOCAPTURE */
1, /* META_OPTIONS */
1, /* META_POSIX */
1, /* META_POSIX_NEG */
0, /* META_RANGE_ESCAPED */
0, /* META_RANGE_LITERAL */
SIZEOFFSET, /* META_RECURSE */
1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_RECURSE_BYNAME */
0, /* META_SCRIPT_RUN */
0, /* META_LOOKAHEAD */
0, /* META_LOOKAHEADNOT */
SIZEOFFSET, /* META_LOOKBEHIND */
SIZEOFFSET, /* META_LOOKBEHINDNOT */
0, /* META_LOOKAHEAD_NA */
SIZEOFFSET, /* META_LOOKBEHIND_NA */
1, /* META_MARK - plus the string length */
0, /* META_ACCEPT */
0, /* META_FAIL */
0, /* META_COMMIT */
1, /* META_COMMIT_ARG - plus the string length */
0, /* META_PRUNE */
1, /* META_PRUNE_ARG - plus the string length */
0, /* META_SKIP */
1, /* META_SKIP_ARG - plus the string length */
0, /* META_THEN */
1, /* META_THEN_ARG - plus the string length */
0, /* META_ASTERISK */
0, /* META_ASTERISK_PLUS */
0, /* META_ASTERISK_QUERY */
0, /* META_PLUS */
0, /* META_PLUS_PLUS */
0, /* META_PLUS_QUERY */
0, /* META_QUERY */
0, /* META_QUERY_PLUS */
0, /* META_QUERY_QUERY */
2, /* META_MINMAX */
2, /* META_MINMAX_PLUS */
2 /* META_MINMAX_QUERY */
};
/* Types for skipping parts of a parsed pattern. */
enum { PSKIP_ALT, PSKIP_CLASS, PSKIP_KET };
/* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. It took some
experimenting to figure out how to stop gcc 5.3.0 from warning with
-Wconversion. This version gets a warning:
#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (uint8_t)(1u << ((b)&7))
Let's hope the apparently less efficient version isn't actually so bad if the
compiler is clever with identical subexpressions. */
#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] = (uint8_t)(a[(b)/8] | (1u << ((b)&7)))
/* Values and flags for the unsigned xxcuflags variables that accompany xxcu
variables, which are concerned with first and required code units. A value
greater than or equal to REQ_NONE means "no code unit set"; otherwise the
matching xxcu variable is set, and the low valued bits are relevant. */
#define REQ_UNSET 0xffffffffu /* Not yet found anything */
#define REQ_NONE 0xfffffffeu /* Found not fixed character */
#define REQ_CASELESS 0x00000001u /* Code unit in xxcu is caseless */
#define REQ_VARY 0x00000002u /* Code unit is followed by non-literal */
/* These flags are used in the groupinfo vector. */
#define GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH 0x80000000u
#define GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH 0x40000000u
#define GI_FIXED_LENGTH_MASK 0x0000ffffu
/* This simple test for a decimal digit works for both ASCII/Unicode and EBCDIC
and is fast (a good compiler can turn it into a subtraction and unsigned
comparison). */
#define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9)
/* Table to identify hex digits. The tables in chartables are dependent on the
locale, and may mark arbitrary characters as digits. We want to recognize only
0-9, a-z, and A-Z as hex digits, which is why we have a private table here. It
costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing character value tests (at
least in some simple cases I timed), and in some applications one wants PCRE2
to compile efficiently as well as match efficiently. The value in the table is
the binary hex digit value, or 0xff for non-hex digits. */
/* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in
UTF-8 mode. */
#ifndef EBCDIC
static const uint8_t xdigitab[] =
{
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 0- 7 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 8- 15 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 16- 23 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 24- 31 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* - ' */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* ( - / */
0x00,0x01,0x02,0x03,0x04,0x05,0x06,0x07, /* 0 - 7 */
0x08,0x09,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 8 - ? */
0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* @ - G */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* H - O */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* P - W */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* X - _ */
0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* ` - g */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* h - o */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* p - w */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* x -127 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 128-135 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 136-143 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 144-151 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 152-159 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 160-167 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 168-175 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 176-183 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 184-191 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 192-199 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 2ff-207 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 208-215 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 216-223 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 224-231 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 232-239 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 240-247 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff};/* 248-255 */
#else
/* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */
static const uint8_t xdigitab[] =
{
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 0- 7 0 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 8- 15 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 16- 23 10 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 24- 31 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 32- 39 20 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 40- 47 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 48- 55 30 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 56- 63 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* - 71 40 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 72- | */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* & - 87 50 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 88- 95 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* - -103 60 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 104- ? */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 112-119 70 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 120- " */
0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* 128- g 80 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* h -143 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 144- p 90 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* q -159 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 160- x A0 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* y -175 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* ^ -183 B0 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 184-191 */
0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* { - G C0 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* H -207 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* } - P D0 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* Q -223 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* \ - X E0 */
0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* Y -239 */
0x00,0x01,0x02,0x03,0x04,0x05,0x06,0x07, /* 0 - 7 F0 */
0x08,0x09,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff};/* 8 -255 */
#endif /* EBCDIC */
/* Table for handling alphanumeric escaped characters. Positive returns are
simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so on.
Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape is
invalid. */
/* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running
in UTF-8 mode. It runs from '0' to 'z'. */
#ifndef EBCDIC
#define ESCAPES_FIRST CHAR_0
#define ESCAPES_LAST CHAR_z
#define UPPER_CASE(c) (c-32)
static const short int escapes[] = {
0, 0,
0, 0,
0, 0,
0, 0,
0, 0,
CHAR_COLON, CHAR_SEMICOLON,
CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN,
CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT, -ESC_A,
-ESC_B, -ESC_C,
-ESC_D, -ESC_E,
0, -ESC_G,
-ESC_H, 0,
0, -ESC_K,
0, 0,
-ESC_N, 0,
-ESC_P, -ESC_Q,
-ESC_R, -ESC_S,
0, 0,
-ESC_V, -ESC_W,
-ESC_X, 0,
-ESC_Z, CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT, CHAR_UNDERSCORE,
CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT, CHAR_BEL,
-ESC_b, 0,
-ESC_d, CHAR_ESC,
CHAR_FF, 0,
-ESC_h, 0,
0, -ESC_k,
0, 0,
CHAR_LF, 0,
-ESC_p, 0,
CHAR_CR, -ESC_s,
CHAR_HT, 0,
-ESC_v, -ESC_w,
0, 0,
-ESC_z
};
#else
/* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support.
It runs from 'a' to '9'. For some minimal testing of EBCDIC features, the code
is sometimes compiled on an ASCII system. In this case, we must not use CHAR_a
because it is defined as 'a', which of course picks up the ASCII value. */
#if 'a' == 0x81 /* Check for a real EBCDIC environment */
#define ESCAPES_FIRST CHAR_a
#define ESCAPES_LAST CHAR_9
#define UPPER_CASE(c) (c+64)
#else /* Testing in an ASCII environment */
#define ESCAPES_FIRST ((unsigned char)'\x81') /* EBCDIC 'a' */
#define ESCAPES_LAST ((unsigned char)'\xf9') /* EBCDIC '9' */
#define UPPER_CASE(c) (c-32)
#endif
static const short int escapes[] = {
/* 80 */ CHAR_BEL, -ESC_b, 0, -ESC_d, CHAR_ESC, CHAR_FF, 0,
/* 88 */ -ESC_h, 0, 0, '{', 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* 90 */ 0, 0, -ESC_k, 0, 0, CHAR_LF, 0, -ESC_p,
/* 98 */ 0, CHAR_CR, 0, '}', 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* A0 */ 0, '~', -ESC_s, CHAR_HT, 0, -ESC_v, -ESC_w, 0,
/* A8 */ 0, -ESC_z, 0, 0, 0, '[', 0, 0,
/* B0 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* B8 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ']', '=', '-',
/* C0 */ '{', -ESC_A, -ESC_B, -ESC_C, -ESC_D, -ESC_E, 0, -ESC_G,
/* C8 */ -ESC_H, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* D0 */ '}', 0, -ESC_K, 0, 0, -ESC_N, 0, -ESC_P,
/* D8 */ -ESC_Q, -ESC_R, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* E0 */ '\\', 0, -ESC_S, 0, 0, -ESC_V, -ESC_W, -ESC_X,
/* E8 */ 0, -ESC_Z, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* F0 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
/* F8 */ 0, 0
};
/* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC
environment for characters 0-31. */
static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_";
#endif /* EBCDIC */
/* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is
searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce
the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The
string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC
platforms. */
typedef struct verbitem {
unsigned int len; /* Length of verb name */
uint32_t meta; /* Base META_ code */
int has_arg; /* Argument requirement */
} verbitem;
static const char verbnames[] =
"\0" /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */
STRING_MARK0
STRING_ACCEPT0
STRING_F0
STRING_FAIL0
STRING_COMMIT0
STRING_PRUNE0
STRING_SKIP0
STRING_THEN;
static const verbitem verbs[] = {
{ 0, META_MARK, +1 }, /* > 0 => must have an argument */
{ 4, META_MARK, +1 },
{ 6, META_ACCEPT, -1 }, /* < 0 => Optional argument, convert to pre-MARK */
{ 1, META_FAIL, -1 },
{ 4, META_FAIL, -1 },
{ 6, META_COMMIT, 0 },
{ 5, META_PRUNE, 0 }, /* Optional argument; bump META code if found */
{ 4, META_SKIP, 0 },
{ 4, META_THEN, 0 }
};
static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem);
/* Verb opcodes, indexed by their META code offset from META_MARK. */
static const uint32_t verbops[] = {
OP_MARK, OP_ACCEPT, OP_FAIL, OP_COMMIT, OP_COMMIT_ARG, OP_PRUNE,
OP_PRUNE_ARG, OP_SKIP, OP_SKIP_ARG, OP_THEN, OP_THEN_ARG };
/* Table of "alpha assertions" like (*pla:...), similar to the (*VERB) table. */
typedef struct alasitem {
unsigned int len; /* Length of name */
uint32_t meta; /* Base META_ code */
} alasitem;
static const char alasnames[] =
STRING_pla0
STRING_plb0
STRING_napla0
STRING_naplb0
STRING_nla0
STRING_nlb0
STRING_positive_lookahead0
STRING_positive_lookbehind0
STRING_non_atomic_positive_lookahead0
STRING_non_atomic_positive_lookbehind0
STRING_negative_lookahead0
STRING_negative_lookbehind0
STRING_atomic0
STRING_sr0
STRING_asr0
STRING_script_run0
STRING_atomic_script_run;
static const alasitem alasmeta[] = {
{ 3, META_LOOKAHEAD },
{ 3, META_LOOKBEHIND },
{ 5, META_LOOKAHEAD_NA },
{ 5, META_LOOKBEHIND_NA },
{ 3, META_LOOKAHEADNOT },
{ 3, META_LOOKBEHINDNOT },
{ 18, META_LOOKAHEAD },
{ 19, META_LOOKBEHIND },
{ 29, META_LOOKAHEAD_NA },
{ 30, META_LOOKBEHIND_NA },
{ 18, META_LOOKAHEADNOT },
{ 19, META_LOOKBEHINDNOT },
{ 6, META_ATOMIC },
{ 2, META_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* sr = script run */
{ 3, META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* asr = atomic script run */
{ 10, META_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* script run */
{ 17, META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN } /* atomic script run */
};
static const int alascount = sizeof(alasmeta)/sizeof(alasitem);
/* Offsets from OP_STAR for case-independent and negative repeat opcodes. */
static uint32_t chartypeoffset[] = {
OP_STAR - OP_STAR, OP_STARI - OP_STAR,
OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR, OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR };
/* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are
now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared
library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero
length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed
for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are
needed, so identify them. */
static const char posix_names[] =
STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0
STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0
STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0
STRING_word0 STRING_xdigit;
static const uint8_t posix_name_lengths[] = {
5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 };
#define PC_GRAPH 8
#define PC_PRINT 9
#define PC_PUNCT 10
/* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a
base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some
classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space
characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore
character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset,
second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map
addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The
absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 =>
remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */
static const int posix_class_maps[] = {
cbit_word, cbit_digit, -2, /* alpha */
cbit_lower, -1, 0, /* lower */
cbit_upper, -1, 0, /* upper */
cbit_word, -1, 2, /* alnum - word without underscore */
cbit_print, cbit_cntrl, 0, /* ascii */
cbit_space, -1, 1, /* blank - a GNU extension */
cbit_cntrl, -1, 0, /* cntrl */
cbit_digit, -1, 0, /* digit */
cbit_graph, -1, 0, /* graph */
cbit_print, -1, 0, /* print */
cbit_punct, -1, 0, /* punct */
cbit_space, -1, 0, /* space */
cbit_word, -1, 0, /* word - a Perl extension */
cbit_xdigit,-1, 0 /* xdigit */
};
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
/* The POSIX class Unicode property substitutes that are used in UCP mode must
be in the order of the POSIX class names, defined above. */
static int posix_substitutes[] = {
PT_GC, ucp_L, /* alpha */
PT_PC, ucp_Ll, /* lower */
PT_PC, ucp_Lu, /* upper */
PT_ALNUM, 0, /* alnum */
-1, 0, /* ascii, treat as non-UCP */
-1, 1, /* blank, treat as \h */
PT_PC, ucp_Cc, /* cntrl */
PT_PC, ucp_Nd, /* digit */
PT_PXGRAPH, 0, /* graph */
PT_PXPRINT, 0, /* print */
PT_PXPUNCT, 0, /* punct */
PT_PXSPACE, 0, /* space */ /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
PT_WORD, 0, /* word */ /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
-1, 0 /* xdigit, treat as non-UCP */
};
#define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / (2*sizeof(uint32_t)))
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/* Masks for checking option settings. When PCRE2_LITERAL is set, only a subset
are allowed. */
#define PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS \
(PCRE2_ANCHORED|PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT|PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_ENDANCHORED| \
PCRE2_FIRSTLINE|PCRE2_LITERAL|PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF| \
PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE|PCRE2_NO_UTF_CHECK|PCRE2_USE_OFFSET_LIMIT|PCRE2_UTF)
#define PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS \
(PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS| \
PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS|PCRE2_ALT_BSUX|PCRE2_ALT_CIRCUMFLEX| \
PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES|PCRE2_DOLLAR_ENDONLY|PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_DUPNAMES| \
PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE|PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF| \
PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NEVER_BACKSLASH_C|PCRE2_NEVER_UCP| \
PCRE2_NEVER_UTF|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS| \
PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR|PCRE2_UCP|PCRE2_UNGREEDY)
#define PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS \
(PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE|PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD)
#define PUBLIC_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS \
(PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS| \
PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES|PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL| \
PCRE2_EXTRA_ESCAPED_CR_IS_LF|PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX| \
PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_LOOKAROUND_BSK)
/* Compile time error code numbers. They are given names so that they can more
easily be tracked. When a new number is added, the tables called eint1 and
eint2 in pcre2posix.c may need to be updated, and a new error text must be
added to compile_error_texts in pcre2_error.c. Also, the error codes in
pcre2.h.in must be updated - their values are exactly 100 greater than these
values. */
enum { ERR0 = COMPILE_ERROR_BASE,
ERR1, ERR2, ERR3, ERR4, ERR5, ERR6, ERR7, ERR8, ERR9, ERR10,
ERR11, ERR12, ERR13, ERR14, ERR15, ERR16, ERR17, ERR18, ERR19, ERR20,
ERR21, ERR22, ERR23, ERR24, ERR25, ERR26, ERR27, ERR28, ERR29, ERR30,
ERR31, ERR32, ERR33, ERR34, ERR35, ERR36, ERR37, ERR38, ERR39, ERR40,
ERR41, ERR42, ERR43, ERR44, ERR45, ERR46, ERR47, ERR48, ERR49, ERR50,
ERR51, ERR52, ERR53, ERR54, ERR55, ERR56, ERR57, ERR58, ERR59, ERR60,
ERR61, ERR62, ERR63, ERR64, ERR65, ERR66, ERR67, ERR68, ERR69, ERR70,
ERR71, ERR72, ERR73, ERR74, ERR75, ERR76, ERR77, ERR78, ERR79, ERR80,
ERR81, ERR82, ERR83, ERR84, ERR85, ERR86, ERR87, ERR88, ERR89, ERR90,
ERR91, ERR92, ERR93, ERR94, ERR95, ERR96, ERR97, ERR98, ERR99 };
/* This is a table of start-of-pattern options such as (*UTF) and settings such
as (*LIMIT_MATCH=nnnn) and (*CRLF). For completeness and backward
compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is
generic and always supported. */
enum { PSO_OPT, /* Value is an option bit */
PSO_FLG, /* Value is a flag bit */
PSO_NL, /* Value is a newline type */
PSO_BSR, /* Value is a \R type */
PSO_LIMH, /* Read integer value for heap limit */
PSO_LIMM, /* Read integer value for match limit */
PSO_LIMD }; /* Read integer value for depth limit */
typedef struct pso {
const uint8_t *name;
uint16_t length;
uint16_t type;
uint32_t value;
} pso;
/* NB: STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR contains the length as well */
static pso pso_list[] = {
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UTF },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UTF },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UCP },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NOTEMPTY_RIGHTPAR, 9, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NOTEMPTY_SET },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NOTEMPTY_ATSTART_RIGHTPAR, 17, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NE_ATST_SET },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR, 16, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR_RIGHTPAR, 18, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_JIT_RIGHTPAR, 7, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NOJIT },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR, 13, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_HEAP_EQ, 11, PSO_LIMH, 0 },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ, 12, PSO_LIMM, 0 },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_DEPTH_EQ, 12, PSO_LIMD, 0 },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ, 16, PSO_LIMD, 0 },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR, 3, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_CR },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR, 3, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_LF },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR, 5, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_CRLF },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANY },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_NUL_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_NUL },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 8, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 12, PSO_BSR, PCRE2_BSR_ANYCRLF },
{ (uint8_t *)STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR, 12, PSO_BSR, PCRE2_BSR_UNICODE }
};
/* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified
versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero
value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in
question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT
because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */
static const uint8_t opcode_possessify[] = {
0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 0 - 15 */
0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 16 - 31 */
0, /* NOTI */
OP_POSSTAR, 0, /* STAR, MINSTAR */
OP_POSPLUS, 0, /* PLUS, MINPLUS */
OP_POSQUERY, 0, /* QUERY, MINQUERY */
OP_POSUPTO, 0, /* UPTO, MINUPTO */
0, /* EXACT */
0, 0, 0, 0, /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
OP_POSSTARI, 0, /* STARI, MINSTARI */
OP_POSPLUSI, 0, /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */
OP_POSQUERYI, 0, /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */
OP_POSUPTOI, 0, /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */
0, /* EXACTI */
0, 0, 0, 0, /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0, /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */
OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0, /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */
OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0, /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */
OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0, /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */
0, /* NOTEXACT */
0, 0, 0, 0, /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0, /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */
OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0, /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */
OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0, /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */
OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0, /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */
0, /* NOTEXACTI */
0, 0, 0, 0, /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0, /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */
OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0, /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */
OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0, /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */
OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0, /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */
0, /* TYPEEXACT */
0, 0, 0, 0, /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0, /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */
OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0, /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */
OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0, /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */
OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0, /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */
0, 0, 0, 0, /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */
0, 0, 0, /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */
0, 0, /* REF, REFI */
0, 0, /* DNREF, DNREFI */
0, 0 /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */
};
#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
/*************************************************
* Show the parsed pattern for debugging *
*************************************************/
/* For debugging the pre-scan, this code, which outputs the parsed data vector,
can be enabled. */
static void show_parsed(compile_block *cb)
{
uint32_t *pptr = cb->parsed_pattern;
for (;;)
{
int max, min;
PCRE2_SIZE offset;
uint32_t i;
uint32_t length;
uint32_t meta_arg = META_DATA(*pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "+++ %02d %.8x ", (int)(pptr - cb->parsed_pattern), *pptr);
if (*pptr < META_END)
{
if (*pptr > 32 && *pptr < 128) fprintf(stderr, "%c", *pptr);
pptr++;
}
else switch (META_CODE(*pptr++))
{
default:
fprintf(stderr, "**** OOPS - unknown META value - giving up ****\n");
return;
case META_END:
fprintf(stderr, "META_END\n");
return;
case META_CAPTURE:
fprintf(stderr, "META_CAPTURE %d", meta_arg);
break;
case META_RECURSE:
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "META_RECURSE %d %zd", meta_arg, offset);
break;
case META_BACKREF:
if (meta_arg < 10)
offset = cb->small_ref_offset[meta_arg];
else
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "META_BACKREF %d %zd", meta_arg, offset);
break;
case META_ESCAPE:
if (meta_arg == ESC_P || meta_arg == ESC_p)
{
uint32_t ptype = *pptr >> 16;
uint32_t pvalue = *pptr++ & 0xffff;
fprintf(stderr, "META \\%c %d %d", (meta_arg == ESC_P)? 'P':'p',
ptype, pvalue);
}
else
{
uint32_t cc;
/* There's just one escape we might have here that isn't negated in the
escapes table. */
if (meta_arg == ESC_g) cc = CHAR_g;
else for (cc = ESCAPES_FIRST; cc <= ESCAPES_LAST; cc++)
{
if (meta_arg == (uint32_t)(-escapes[cc - ESCAPES_FIRST])) break;
}
if (cc > ESCAPES_LAST) cc = CHAR_QUESTION_MARK;
fprintf(stderr, "META \\%c", cc);
}
break;
case META_MINMAX:
min = *pptr++;
max = *pptr++;
if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}", min, max);
else
fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}", min);
break;
case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
min = *pptr++;
max = *pptr++;
if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}?", min, max);
else
fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}?", min);
break;
case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
min = *pptr++;
max = *pptr++;
if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}+", min, max);
else
fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}+", min);
break;
case META_BIGVALUE: fprintf(stderr, "META_BIGVALUE %.8x", *pptr++); break;
case META_CIRCUMFLEX: fprintf(stderr, "META_CIRCUMFLEX"); break;
case META_COND_ASSERT: fprintf(stderr, "META_COND_ASSERT"); break;
case META_DOLLAR: fprintf(stderr, "META_DOLLAR"); break;
case META_DOT: fprintf(stderr, "META_DOT"); break;
case META_ASTERISK: fprintf(stderr, "META *"); break;
case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META *?"); break;
case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META *+"); break;
case META_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META +"); break;
case META_PLUS_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META +?"); break;
case META_PLUS_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META ++"); break;
case META_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META ?"); break;
case META_QUERY_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META ??"); break;
case META_QUERY_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META ?+"); break;
case META_ATOMIC: fprintf(stderr, "META (?>"); break;
case META_NOCAPTURE: fprintf(stderr, "META (?:"); break;
case META_LOOKAHEAD: fprintf(stderr, "META (?="); break;
case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: fprintf(stderr, "META (?!"); break;
case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: fprintf(stderr, "META (*napla:"); break;
case META_SCRIPT_RUN: fprintf(stderr, "META (*sr:"); break;
case META_KET: fprintf(stderr, "META )"); break;
case META_ALT: fprintf(stderr, "META | %d", meta_arg); break;
case META_CLASS: fprintf(stderr, "META ["); break;
case META_CLASS_NOT: fprintf(stderr, "META [^"); break;
case META_CLASS_END: fprintf(stderr, "META ]"); break;
case META_CLASS_EMPTY: fprintf(stderr, "META []"); break;
case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT: fprintf(stderr, "META [^]"); break;
case META_RANGE_LITERAL: fprintf(stderr, "META - (literal)"); break;
case META_RANGE_ESCAPED: fprintf(stderr, "META - (escaped)"); break;
case META_POSIX: fprintf(stderr, "META_POSIX %d", *pptr++); break;
case META_POSIX_NEG: fprintf(stderr, "META_POSIX_NEG %d", *pptr++); break;
case META_ACCEPT: fprintf(stderr, "META (*ACCEPT)"); break;
case META_FAIL: fprintf(stderr, "META (*FAIL)"); break;
case META_COMMIT: fprintf(stderr, "META (*COMMIT)"); break;
case META_PRUNE: fprintf(stderr, "META (*PRUNE)"); break;
case META_SKIP: fprintf(stderr, "META (*SKIP)"); break;
case META_THEN: fprintf(stderr, "META (*THEN)"); break;
case META_OPTIONS: fprintf(stderr, "META_OPTIONS 0x%02x", *pptr++); break;
case META_LOOKBEHIND:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?<= %d offset=", meta_arg);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
fprintf(stderr, "META (*naplb: %d offset=", meta_arg);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?<! %d offset=", meta_arg);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?C%d) next=%d/%d", pptr[2], pptr[0],
pptr[1]);
pptr += 3;
break;
case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
{
uint32_t patoffset = *pptr++; /* Offset of next pattern item */
uint32_t patlength = *pptr++; /* Length of next pattern item */
fprintf(stderr, "META (?Cstring) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd next=%d/%d", offset, patoffset, patlength);
}
break;
case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?(&name) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
fprintf(stderr, "META_BACKREF_BYNAME length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_COND_NUMBER:
fprintf(stderr, "META_COND_NUMBER %d offset=", pptr[SIZEOFFSET]);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
pptr++;
break;
case META_COND_DEFINE:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?(DEFINE) offset=");
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_COND_VERSION:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?(VERSION%s", (*pptr++ == 0)? "=" : ">=");
fprintf(stderr, "%d.", *pptr++);
fprintf(stderr, "%d)", *pptr++);
break;
case META_COND_NAME:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?(<name>) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_COND_RNAME:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?(R&name) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
/* This is kept as a name, because it might be. */
case META_COND_RNUMBER:
fprintf(stderr, "META (?(Rnumber) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
break;
case META_MARK:
fprintf(stderr, "META (*MARK:");
goto SHOWARG;
case META_COMMIT_ARG:
fprintf(stderr, "META (*COMMIT:");
goto SHOWARG;
case META_PRUNE_ARG:
fprintf(stderr, "META (*PRUNE:");
goto SHOWARG;
case META_SKIP_ARG:
fprintf(stderr, "META (*SKIP:");
goto SHOWARG;
case META_THEN_ARG:
fprintf(stderr, "META (*THEN:");
SHOWARG:
length = *pptr++;
for (i = 0; i < length; i++)
{
uint32_t cc = *pptr++;
if (cc > 32 && cc < 128) fprintf(stderr, "%c", cc);
else fprintf(stderr, "\\x{%x}", cc);
}
fprintf(stderr, ") length=%u", length);
break;
}
fprintf(stderr, "\n");
}
return;
}
#endif /* DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED */
/*************************************************
* Copy compiled code *
*************************************************/
/* Compiled JIT code cannot be copied, so the new compiled block has no
associated JIT data. */
PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
pcre2_code_copy(const pcre2_code *code)
{
PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count;
pcre2_code *newcode;
if (code == NULL) return NULL;
newcode = code->memctl.malloc(code->blocksize, code->memctl.memory_data);
if (newcode == NULL) return NULL;
memcpy(newcode, code, code->blocksize);
newcode->executable_jit = NULL;
/* If the code is one that has been deserialized, increment the reference count
in the decoded tables. */
if ((code->flags & PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES) != 0)
{
ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(code->tables + TABLES_LENGTH);
(*ref_count)++;
}
return newcode;
}
/*************************************************
* Copy compiled code and character tables *
*************************************************/
/* Compiled JIT code cannot be copied, so the new compiled block has no
associated JIT data. This version of code_copy also makes a separate copy of
the character tables. */
PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
pcre2_code_copy_with_tables(const pcre2_code *code)
{
PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count;
pcre2_code *newcode;
uint8_t *newtables;
if (code == NULL) return NULL;
newcode = code->memctl.malloc(code->blocksize, code->memctl.memory_data);
if (newcode == NULL) return NULL;
memcpy(newcode, code, code->blocksize);
newcode->executable_jit = NULL;
newtables = code->memctl.malloc(TABLES_LENGTH + sizeof(PCRE2_SIZE),
code->memctl.memory_data);
if (newtables == NULL)
{
code->memctl.free((void *)newcode, code->memctl.memory_data);
return NULL;
}
memcpy(newtables, code->tables, TABLES_LENGTH);
ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(newtables + TABLES_LENGTH);
*ref_count = 1;
newcode->tables = newtables;
newcode->flags |= PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES;
return newcode;
}
/*************************************************
* Free compiled code *
*************************************************/
PCRE2_EXP_DEFN void PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
pcre2_code_free(pcre2_code *code)
{
PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count;
if (code != NULL)
{
#ifdef SUPPORT_JIT
if (code->executable_jit != NULL)
PRIV(jit_free)(code->executable_jit, &code->memctl);
#endif
if ((code->flags & PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES) != 0)
{
/* Decoded tables belong to the codes after deserialization, and they must
be freed when there are no more references to them. The *ref_count should
always be > 0. */
ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(code->tables + TABLES_LENGTH);
if (*ref_count > 0)
{
(*ref_count)--;
if (*ref_count == 0)
code->memctl.free((void *)code->tables, code->memctl.memory_data);
}
}
code->memctl.free(code, code->memctl.memory_data);
}
}
/*************************************************
* Read a number, possibly signed *
*************************************************/
/* This function is used to read numbers in the pattern. The initial pointer
must be the sign or first digit of the number. When relative values (introduced
by + or -) are allowed, they are relative group numbers, and the result must be
greater than zero.
Arguments:
ptrptr points to the character pointer variable
ptrend points to the end of the input string
allow_sign if < 0, sign not allowed; if >= 0, sign is relative to this
max_value the largest number allowed
max_error the error to give for an over-large number
intptr where to put the result
errcodeptr where to put an error code
Returns: TRUE - a number was read
FALSE - errorcode == 0 => no number was found
errorcode != 0 => an error occurred
*/
static BOOL
read_number(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, int32_t allow_sign,
uint32_t max_value, uint32_t max_error, int *intptr, int *errorcodeptr)
{
int sign = 0;
uint32_t n = 0;
PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
BOOL yield = FALSE;
*errorcodeptr = 0;
if (allow_sign >= 0 && ptr < ptrend)
{
if (*ptr == CHAR_PLUS)
{
sign = +1;
max_value -= allow_sign;
ptr++;
}
else if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS)
{
sign = -1;
ptr++;
}
}
if (ptr >= ptrend || !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) return FALSE;
while (ptr < ptrend && IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
{
n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
if (n > max_value)
{
*errorcodeptr = max_error;
goto EXIT;
}
}
if (allow_sign >= 0 && sign != 0)
{
if (n == 0)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR26; /* +0 and -0 are not allowed */
goto EXIT;
}
if (sign > 0) n += allow_sign;
else if ((int)n > allow_sign)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */
goto EXIT;
}
else n = allow_sign + 1 - n;
}
yield = TRUE;
EXIT:
*intptr = n;
*ptrptr = ptr;
return yield;
}
/*************************************************
* Read repeat counts *
*************************************************/
/* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values if non-NULL pointers
are supplied. Repeat counts must be less than 65536 (MAX_REPEAT_COUNT); a
larger value is used for "unlimited". We have to use signed arguments for
read_number() because it is capable of returning a signed value.
Arguments:
ptrptr points to pointer to character after'{'
ptrend pointer to end of input
minp if not NULL, pointer to int for min
maxp if not NULL, pointer to int for max (-1 if no max)
returned as -1 if no max
errorcodeptr points to error code variable
Returns: FALSE if not a repeat quantifier, errorcode set zero
FALSE on error, with errorcode set non-zero
TRUE on success, with pointer updated to point after '}'
*/
static BOOL
read_repeat_counts(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, uint32_t *minp,
uint32_t *maxp, int *errorcodeptr)
{
PCRE2_SPTR p;
BOOL yield = FALSE;
BOOL had_comma = FALSE;
int32_t min = 0;
int32_t max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED; /* This value is larger than MAX_REPEAT_COUNT */
/* Check the syntax */
*errorcodeptr = 0;
for (p = *ptrptr;; p++)
{
uint32_t c;
if (p >= ptrend) return FALSE;
c = *p;
if (IS_DIGIT(c)) continue;
if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
if (c == CHAR_COMMA)
{
if (had_comma) return FALSE;
had_comma = TRUE;
}
else return FALSE;
}
/* The only error from read_number() is for a number that is too big. */
p = *ptrptr;
if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, -1, MAX_REPEAT_COUNT, ERR5, &min, errorcodeptr))
goto EXIT;
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
p++;
max = min;
}
else
{
if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, -1, MAX_REPEAT_COUNT, ERR5, &max,
errorcodeptr))
goto EXIT;
if (max < min)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR4;
goto EXIT;
}
}
p++;
}
yield = TRUE;
if (minp != NULL) *minp = (uint32_t)min;
if (maxp != NULL) *maxp = (uint32_t)max;
/* Update the pattern pointer */
EXIT:
*ptrptr = p;
return yield;
}
/*************************************************
* Handle escapes *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a
positive value for a simple escape such as \d, or 0 for a data character, which
is placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n. On
entry, ptr is pointing at the character after \. On exit, it points after the
final code unit of the escape sequence.
This function is also called from pcre2_substitute() to handle escape sequences
in replacement strings. In this case, the cb argument is NULL, and in the case
of escapes that have further processing, only sequences that define a data
character are recognised. The isclass argument is not relevant; the options
argument is the final value of the compiled pattern's options.
Arguments:
ptrptr points to the input position pointer
ptrend points to the end of the input
chptr points to a returned data character
errorcodeptr points to the errorcode variable (containing zero)
options the current options bits
isclass TRUE if inside a character class
cb compile data block or NULL when called from pcre2_substitute()
Returns: zero => a data character
positive => a special escape sequence
negative => a numerical back reference
on error, errorcodeptr is set non-zero
*/
int
PRIV(check_escape)(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, uint32_t *chptr,
int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t options, uint32_t extra_options, BOOL isclass,
compile_block *cb)
{
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
uint32_t c, cc;
int escape = 0;
int i;
/* If backslash is at the end of the string, it's an error. */
if (ptr >= ptrend)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR1;
return 0;
}
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */
*errorcodeptr = 0; /* Be optimistic */
/* Non-alphanumerics are literals, so we just leave the value in c. An initial
value test saves a memory lookup for code points outside the alphanumeric
range. */
if (c < ESCAPES_FIRST || c > ESCAPES_LAST) {} /* Definitely literal */
/* Otherwise, do a table lookup. Non-zero values need little processing here. A
positive value is a literal value for something like \n. A negative value is
the negation of one of the ESC_ macros that is passed back for handling by the
calling function. Some extra checking is needed for \N because only \N{U+dddd}
is supported. If the value is zero, further processing is handled below. */
else if ((i = escapes[c - ESCAPES_FIRST]) != 0)
{
if (i > 0)
{
c = (uint32_t)i;
if (c == CHAR_CR && (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ESCAPED_CR_IS_LF) != 0)
c = CHAR_LF;
}
else /* Negative table entry */
{
escape = -i; /* Else return a special escape */
if (cb != NULL && (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p || escape == ESC_X))
cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASBKPORX; /* Note \P, \p, or \X */
/* Perl supports \N{name} for character names and \N{U+dddd} for numerical
Unicode code points, as well as plain \N for "not newline". PCRE does not
support \N{name}. However, it does support quantification such as \N{2,3},
so if \N{ is not followed by U+dddd we check for a quantifier. */
if (escape == ESC_N && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1;
/* \N{U+ can be handled by the \x{ code. However, this construction is
not valid in EBCDIC environments because it specifies a Unicode
character, not a codepoint in the local code. For example \N{U+0041}
must be "A" in all environments. Also, in Perl, \N{U+ forces Unicode
casing semantics for the entire pattern, so allow it only in UTF (i.e.
Unicode) mode. */
if (ptrend - p > 1 && *p == CHAR_U && p[1] == CHAR_PLUS)
{
#ifdef EBCDIC
*errorcodeptr = ERR93;
#else
if (utf)
{
ptr = p + 1;
escape = 0; /* Not a fancy escape after all */
goto COME_FROM_NU;
}
else *errorcodeptr = ERR93;
#endif
}
/* Give an error if what follows is not a quantifier, but don't override
an error set by the quantifier reader (e.g. number overflow). */
else
{
if (!read_repeat_counts(&p, ptrend, NULL, NULL, errorcodeptr) &&
*errorcodeptr == 0)
*errorcodeptr = ERR37;
}
}
}
}
/* Escapes that need further processing, including those that are unknown, have
a zero entry in the lookup table. When called from pcre2_substitute(), only \c,
\o, and \x are recognized (\u and \U can never appear as they are used for case
forcing). */
else
{
int s;
PCRE2_SPTR oldptr;
BOOL overflow;
BOOL alt_bsux =
((options & PCRE2_ALT_BSUX) | (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX)) != 0;
/* Filter calls from pcre2_substitute(). */
if (cb == NULL)
{
if (c != CHAR_c && c != CHAR_o && c != CHAR_x)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR3;
return 0;
}
alt_bsux = FALSE; /* Do not modify \x handling */
}
switch (c)
{
/* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit
error. */
case CHAR_F:
case CHAR_l:
case CHAR_L:
*errorcodeptr = ERR37;
break;
/* \u is unrecognized when neither PCRE2_ALT_BSUX nor PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX
is set. Otherwise, \u must be followed by exactly four hex digits or, if
PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, by any number of hex digits in braces.
Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. This gives some compatibility with
ECMAScript (aka JavaScript). */
case CHAR_u:
if (!alt_bsux) *errorcodeptr = ERR37; else
{
uint32_t xc;
if (ptr >= ptrend) break;
if (*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
(extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX) != 0)
{
PCRE2_SPTR hptr = ptr + 1;
cc = 0;
while (hptr < ptrend && (xc = XDIGIT(*hptr)) != 0xff)
{
if ((cc & 0xf0000000) != 0) /* Test for 32-bit overflow */
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR77;
ptr = hptr; /* Show where */
break; /* *hptr != } will cause another break below */
}
cc = (cc << 4) | xc;
hptr++;
}
if (hptr == ptr + 1 || /* No hex digits */
hptr >= ptrend || /* Hit end of input */
*hptr != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) /* No } terminator */
break; /* Hex escape not recognized */
c = cc; /* Accept the code point */
ptr = hptr + 1;
}
else /* Must be exactly 4 hex digits */
{
if (ptrend - ptr < 4) break; /* Less than 4 chars */
if ((cc = XDIGIT(ptr[0])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[1])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
cc = (cc << 4) | xc;
if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[2])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
cc = (cc << 4) | xc;
if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[3])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
c = (cc << 4) | xc;
ptr += 4;
}
if (utf)
{
if (c > 0x10ffffU) *errorcodeptr = ERR77;
else
if (c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff &&
(extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0)
*errorcodeptr = ERR73;
}
else if (c > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR) *errorcodeptr = ERR77;
}
break;
/* \U is unrecognized unless PCRE2_ALT_BSUX or PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set,
in which case it is an upper case letter. */
case CHAR_U:
if (!alt_bsux) *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
break;
/* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character
class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things:
(1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute
backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl
5.10 feature.
(2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This
is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As
this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really
was \k{name}.
(3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a
number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are
(possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. We return
the ESC_g code.
Summary: Return a negative number for a numerical back reference, ESC_k for
a named back reference, and ESC_g for a named or numbered subroutine call.
*/
case CHAR_g:
if (isclass) break;
if (ptr >= ptrend)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR57;
break;
}
if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || *ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
{
escape = ESC_g;
break;
}
/* If there is a brace delimiter, try to read a numerical reference. If
there isn't one, assume we have a name and treat it as \k. */
if (*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1;
if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &s,
errorcodeptr))
{
if (*errorcodeptr == 0) escape = ESC_k; /* No number found */
break;
}
if (p >= ptrend || *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR57;
break;
}
ptr = p + 1;
}
/* Read an undelimited number */
else
{
if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &s,
errorcodeptr))
{
if (*errorcodeptr == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR57; /* No number found */
break;
}
}
if (s <= 0)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR15;
break;
}
escape = -s;
break;
/* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits
starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed
over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are
recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax.
Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the
number is less than 10, or if there are that many previous extracting left
brackets, it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to three octal digits are
read to form an escaped character code. Thus \123 is likely to be octal 123
(cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3).
Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal
8 or 9 or an octal number. */
case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5:
case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
if (!isclass)
{
oldptr = ptr;
ptr--; /* Back to the digit */
/* As we know we are at a digit, the only possible error from
read_number() is a number that is too large to be a group number. In this
case we fall through handle this as not a group reference. If we have
read a small enough number, check for a back reference.
\1 to \9 are always back references. \8x and \9x are too; \1x to \7x
are octal escapes if there are not that many previous captures. */
if (read_number(&ptr, ptrend, -1, INT_MAX/10 - 1, 0, &s, errorcodeptr) &&
(s < 10 || oldptr[-1] >= CHAR_8 || s <= (int)cb->bracount))
{
if (s > (int)MAX_GROUP_NUMBER) *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
else escape = -s; /* Indicates a back reference */
break;
}
ptr = oldptr; /* Put the pointer back and fall through */
}
/* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference, or
we are within a character class. If the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to
generate a binary zero and then treat the digit as a following literal. At
least by Perl 5.18 this changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */
if (c >= CHAR_8) break;
/* Fall through */
/* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a
larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least
significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used
to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode,
but no more than 3 octal digits. */
case CHAR_0:
c -= CHAR_0;
while(i++ < 2 && ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
c = c * 8 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51;
#endif
break;
/* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of
specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */
case CHAR_o:
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr++ != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
ptr--;
*errorcodeptr = ERR55;
}
else if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
*errorcodeptr = ERR78;
else
{
c = 0;
overflow = FALSE;
while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
{
cc = *ptr++;
if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue; /* Leading zeroes */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
#endif
c = (c << 3) + (cc - CHAR_0);
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
#endif
}
if (overflow)
{
while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++;
*errorcodeptr = ERR34;
}
else if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff &&
(extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0)
{
ptr--;
*errorcodeptr = ERR73;
}
}
else
{
ptr--;
*errorcodeptr = ERR64;
}
}
break;
/* When PCRE2_ALT_BSUX or PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, \x must be followed
by two hexadecimal digits. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */
case CHAR_x:
if (alt_bsux)
{
uint32_t xc;
if (ptrend - ptr < 2) break; /* Less than 2 characters */
if ((cc = XDIGIT(ptr[0])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[1])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
c = (cc << 4) | xc;
ptr += 2;
}
/* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character code which can be
greater than 0xff in UTF-8 or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex
digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl
seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so
that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE
now gives an error. */
else
{
if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
#ifndef EBCDIC
COME_FROM_NU:
#endif
if (++ptr >= ptrend || *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR78;
break;
}
c = 0;
overflow = FALSE;
while (ptr < ptrend && (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) != 0xff)
{
ptr++;
if (c == 0 && cc == 0) continue; /* Leading zeroes */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
#endif
c = (c << 4) | cc;
if ((utf && c > 0x10ffffU) || (!utf && c > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR))
{
overflow = TRUE;
break;
}
}
if (overflow)
{
while (ptr < ptrend && XDIGIT(*ptr) != 0xff) ptr++;
*errorcodeptr = ERR34;
}
else if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff &&
(extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0)
{
ptr--;
*errorcodeptr = ERR73;
}
}
/* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error.
We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal
\x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more
sensible, so we do too. */
else
{
ptr--;
*errorcodeptr = ERR67;
}
} /* End of \x{} processing */
/* Read a up to two hex digits after \x */
else
{
c = 0;
if (ptr >= ptrend || (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
ptr++;
c = cc;
if (ptr >= ptrend || (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */
ptr++;
c = (c << 4) | cc;
} /* End of \xdd handling */
} /* End of Perl-style \x handling */
break;
/* The handling of \c is different in ASCII and EBCDIC environments. In an
ASCII (or Unicode) environment, an error is given if the character
following \c is not a printable ASCII character. Otherwise, the following
character is upper-cased if it is a letter, and after that the 0x40 bit is
flipped. The result is the value of the escape.
In an EBCDIC environment the handling of \c is compatible with the
specification in the perlebcdic document. The following character must be
a letter or one of small number of special characters. These provide a
means of defining the character values 0-31.
For testing the EBCDIC handling of \c in an ASCII environment, recognize
the EBCDIC value of 'c' explicitly. */
#if defined EBCDIC && 'a' != 0x81
case 0x83:
#else
case CHAR_c:
#endif
if (ptr >= ptrend)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR2;
break;
}
c = *ptr;
if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c = UPPER_CASE(c);
/* Handle \c in an ASCII/Unicode environment. */
#ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
if (c < 32 || c > 126) /* Excludes all non-printable ASCII */
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR68;
break;
}
c ^= 0x40;
/* Handle \c in an EBCDIC environment. The special case \c? is converted to
255 (0xff) or 95 (0x5f) if other characters suggest we are using the
POSIX-BC encoding. (This is the way Perl indicates that it handles \c?.)
The other valid sequences correspond to a list of specific characters. */
#else
if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff;
else
{
for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
{
if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break;
}
if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
}
#endif /* EBCDIC */
ptr++;
break;
/* Any other alphanumeric following \ is an error. Perl gives an error only
if in warning mode, but PCRE doesn't have a warning mode. */
default:
*errorcodeptr = ERR3;
*ptrptr = ptr - 1; /* Point to the character at fault */
return 0;
}
}
/* Set the pointer to the next character before returning. */
*ptrptr = ptr;
*chptr = c;
return escape;
}
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
/*************************************************
* Handle \P and \p *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that
PCRE2 is compiled with support for UTF and Unicode properties. On entry, the
contents of ptrptr are pointing after the P or p. On exit, it is left pointing
after the final code unit of the escape sequence.
Arguments:
ptrptr the pattern position pointer
negptr a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE
ptypeptr an unsigned int that is set to the type value
pdataptr an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value
errorcodeptr the error code variable
cb the compile data
Returns: TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type
*/
static BOOL
get_ucp(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, uint16_t *ptypeptr,
uint16_t *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR c;
PCRE2_SIZE i, bot, top;
PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
PCRE2_UCHAR name[50];
PCRE2_UCHAR *vptr = NULL;
uint16_t ptscript = PT_NOTSCRIPT;
if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
c = *ptr++;
*negptr = FALSE;
/* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for
negation. */
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
{
*negptr = TRUE;
ptr++;
}
for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)) - 1; i++)
{
if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
c = *ptr++;
while (c == '_' || c == '-' || isspace(c))
{
if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
c = *ptr++;
}
if (c == CHAR_NUL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
name[i] = tolower(c);
if ((c == ':' || c == '=') && vptr == NULL) vptr = name + i;
}
if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN;
name[i] = 0;
}
/* If { doesn't follow \p or \P there is just one following character, which
must be an ASCII letter. */
else if (MAX_255(c) && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_letter) != 0)
{
name[0] = tolower(c);
name[1] = 0;
}
else goto ERROR_RETURN;
*ptrptr = ptr;
/* If the property contains ':' or '=' we have class name and value separately
specified. The following are supported:
. Bidi_Class (synonym bc), for which the property names are "bidi<name>".
. Script (synonym sc) for which the property name is the script name
. Script_Extensions (synonym scx), ditto
As this is a small number, we currently just check the names directly. If this
grows, a sorted table and a switch will be neater.
For both the script properties, set a PT_xxx value so that (1) they can be
distinguished and (2) invalid script names that happen to be the name of
another property can be diagnosed. */
if (vptr != NULL)
{
int offset = 0;
PCRE2_UCHAR sname[8];
*vptr = 0; /* Terminate property name */
if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_bidiclass) == 0 ||
PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_bc) == 0)
{
offset = 4;
sname[0] = CHAR_b;
sname[1] = CHAR_i; /* There is no strcpy_c8 function */
sname[2] = CHAR_d;
sname[3] = CHAR_i;
}
else if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_script) == 0 ||
PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_sc) == 0)
ptscript = PT_SC;
else if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_scriptextensions) == 0 ||
PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_scx) == 0)
ptscript = PT_SCX;
else
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR47;
return FALSE;
}
/* Adjust the string in name[] as needed */
memmove(name + offset, vptr + 1, (name + i - vptr)*sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR));
if (offset != 0) memmove(name, sname, offset*sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR));
}
/* Search for a recognized property using binary chop. */
bot = 0;
top = PRIV(utt_size);
while (bot < top)
{
int r;
i = (bot + top) >> 1;
r = PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset);
/* When a matching property is found, some extra checking is needed when the
\p{xx:yy} syntax is used and xx is either sc or scx. */
if (r == 0)
{
*pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value;
if (vptr == NULL || ptscript == PT_NOTSCRIPT)
{
*ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type;
return TRUE;
}
switch (PRIV(utt)[i].type)
{
case PT_SC:
*ptypeptr = PT_SC;
return TRUE;
case PT_SCX:
*ptypeptr = ptscript;
return TRUE;
}
break; /* Non-script found */
}
if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i;
}
*errorcodeptr = ERR47; /* Unrecognized property */
return FALSE;
ERROR_RETURN: /* Malformed \P or \p */
*errorcodeptr = ERR46;
*ptrptr = ptr;
return FALSE;
}
#endif
/*************************************************
* Check for POSIX class syntax *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is
encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a
sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we
reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE.
Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the
terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters,
though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an
"Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE
didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:].
The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We
have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX
class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code
below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other
escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as
[:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does
not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes
when Perl does, I think.
A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not.
It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent
external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or
a digit. This is handled by returning FALSE if the start of a new group with
the same terminator is encountered, since the next closing sequence must close
the nested group, not the outer one.
In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For
example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for
[:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not
seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class
names.
Arguments:
ptr pointer to the character after the initial [ (colon, dot, equals)
ptrend pointer to the end of the pattern
endptr where to return a pointer to the terminating ':', '.', or '='
Returns: TRUE or FALSE
*/
static BOOL
check_posix_syntax(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, PCRE2_SPTR *endptr)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR terminator; /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */
terminator = *ptr++; /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */
for (; ptrend - ptr >= 2; ptr++)
{
if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH &&
(ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH))
ptr++;
else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) ||
*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE;
else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
{
*endptr = ptr;
return TRUE;
}
}
return FALSE;
}
/*************************************************
* Check POSIX class name *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry
such as [:alnum:].
Arguments:
ptr points to the first letter
len the length of the name
Returns: a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown
*/
static int
check_posix_name(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, int len)
{
const char *pn = posix_names;
int yield = 0;
while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0)
{
if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] &&
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield;
pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1;
yield++;
}
return -1;
}
/*************************************************
* Read a subpattern or VERB name *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called from parse_regex() below whenever it needs to read
the name of a subpattern or a (*VERB) or an (*alpha_assertion). The initial
pointer must be to the character before the name. If that character is '*' we
are reading a verb or alpha assertion name. The pointer is updated to point
after the name, for a VERB or alpha assertion name, or after tha name's
terminator for a subpattern name. Returning both the offset and the name
pointer is redundant information, but some callers use one and some the other,
so it is simplest just to return both.
Arguments:
ptrptr points to the character pointer variable
ptrend points to the end of the input string
utf true if the input is UTF-encoded
terminator the terminator of a subpattern name must be this
offsetptr where to put the offset from the start of the pattern
nameptr where to put a pointer to the name in the input
namelenptr where to put the length of the name
errcodeptr where to put an error code
cb pointer to the compile data block
Returns: TRUE if a name was read
FALSE otherwise, with error code set
*/
static BOOL
read_name(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, BOOL utf, uint32_t terminator,
PCRE2_SIZE *offsetptr, PCRE2_SPTR *nameptr, uint32_t *namelenptr,
int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb)
{
PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
BOOL is_group = (*ptr != CHAR_ASTERISK);
if (++ptr >= ptrend) /* No characters in name */
{
*errorcodeptr = is_group? ERR62: /* Subpattern name expected */
ERR60; /* Verb not recognized or malformed */
goto FAILED;
}
*nameptr = ptr;
*offsetptr = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
/* In UTF mode, a group name may contain letters and decimal digits as defined
by Unicode properties, and underscores, but must not start with a digit. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (utf && is_group)
{
uint32_t c, type;
GETCHAR(c, ptr);
type = UCD_CHARTYPE(c);
if (type == ucp_Nd)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR44;
goto FAILED;
}
for(;;)
{
if (type != ucp_Nd && PRIV(ucp_gentype)[type] != ucp_L &&
c != CHAR_UNDERSCORE) break;
ptr++;
FORWARDCHARTEST(ptr, ptrend);
if (ptr >= ptrend) break;
GETCHAR(c, ptr);
type = UCD_CHARTYPE(c);
}
}
else
#else
(void)utf; /* Avoid compiler warning */
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/* Handle non-group names and group names in non-UTF modes. A group name must
not start with a digit. If either of the others start with a digit it just
won't be recognized. */
{
if (is_group && IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR44;
goto FAILED;
}
while (ptr < ptrend && MAX_255(*ptr) && (cb->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0)
{
ptr++;
}
}
/* Check name length */
if (ptr > *nameptr + MAX_NAME_SIZE)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR48;
goto FAILED;
}
*namelenptr = (uint32_t)(ptr - *nameptr);
/* Subpattern names must not be empty, and their terminator is checked here.
(What follows a verb or alpha assertion name is checked separately.) */
if (is_group)
{
if (ptr == *nameptr)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR62; /* Subpattern name expected */
goto FAILED;
}
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != (PCRE2_UCHAR)terminator)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR42;
goto FAILED;
}
ptr++;
}
*ptrptr = ptr;
return TRUE;
FAILED:
*ptrptr = ptr;
return FALSE;
}
/*************************************************
* Manage callouts at start of cycle *
*************************************************/
/* At the start of a new item in parse_regex() we are able to record the
details of the previous item in a prior callout, and also to set up an
automatic callout if enabled. Avoid having two adjacent automatic callouts,
which would otherwise happen for items such as \Q that contribute nothing to
the parsed pattern.
Arguments:
ptr current pattern pointer
pcalloutptr points to a pointer to previous callout, or NULL
auto_callout TRUE if auto_callouts are enabled
parsed_pattern the parsed pattern pointer
cb compile block
Returns: possibly updated parsed_pattern pointer.
*/
static uint32_t *
manage_callouts(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, uint32_t **pcalloutptr, BOOL auto_callout,
uint32_t *parsed_pattern, compile_block *cb)
{
uint32_t *previous_callout = *pcalloutptr;
if (previous_callout != NULL) previous_callout[2] = (uint32_t)(ptr -
cb->start_pattern - (PCRE2_SIZE)previous_callout[1]);
if (!auto_callout) previous_callout = NULL; else
{
if (previous_callout == NULL ||
previous_callout != parsed_pattern - 4 ||
previous_callout[3] != 255)
{
previous_callout = parsed_pattern; /* Set up new automatic callout */
parsed_pattern += 4;
previous_callout[0] = META_CALLOUT_NUMBER;
previous_callout[2] = 0;
previous_callout[3] = 255;
}
previous_callout[1] = (uint32_t)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
}
*pcalloutptr = previous_callout;
return parsed_pattern;
}
/*************************************************
* Parse regex and identify named groups *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called first of all. It scans the pattern and does two
things: (1) It identifies capturing groups and makes a table of named capturing
groups so that information about them is fully available to both the compiling
scans. (2) It writes a parsed version of the pattern with comments omitted and
escapes processed into the parsed_pattern vector.
Arguments:
ptr points to the start of the pattern
options compiling dynamic options (may change during the scan)
has_lookbehind points to a boolean, set TRUE if a lookbehind is found
cb pointer to the compile data block
Returns: zero on success or a non-zero error code, with the
error offset placed in the cb field
*/
/* A structure and some flags for dealing with nested groups. */
typedef struct nest_save {
uint16_t nest_depth;
uint16_t reset_group;
uint16_t max_group;
uint16_t flags;
uint32_t options;
} nest_save;
#define NSF_RESET 0x0001u
#define NSF_CONDASSERT 0x0002u
#define NSF_ATOMICSR 0x0004u
/* Options that are changeable within the pattern must be tracked during
parsing. Some (e.g. PCRE2_EXTENDED) are implemented entirely during parsing,
but all must be tracked so that META_OPTIONS items set the correct values for
the main compiling phase. */
#define PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS (PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_DUPNAMES| \
PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE|PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE| \
PCRE2_UNGREEDY)
/* States used for analyzing ranges in character classes. The two OK values
must be last. */
enum { RANGE_NO, RANGE_STARTED, RANGE_OK_ESCAPED, RANGE_OK_LITERAL };
/* Only in 32-bit mode can there be literals > META_END. A macro encapsulates
the storing of literal values in the main parsed pattern, where they can always
be quantified. */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
#define PARSED_LITERAL(c, p) \
{ \
if (c >= META_END) *p++ = META_BIGVALUE; \
*p++ = c; \
okquantifier = TRUE; \
}
#else
#define PARSED_LITERAL(c, p) *p++ = c; okquantifier = TRUE;
#endif
/* Here's the actual function. */
static int parse_regex(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, uint32_t options, BOOL *has_lookbehind,
compile_block *cb)
{
uint32_t c;
uint32_t delimiter;
uint32_t namelen;
uint32_t class_range_state;
uint32_t *verblengthptr = NULL; /* Value avoids compiler warning */
uint32_t *verbstartptr = NULL;
uint32_t *previous_callout = NULL;
uint32_t *parsed_pattern = cb->parsed_pattern;
uint32_t *parsed_pattern_end = cb->parsed_pattern_end;
uint32_t meta_quantifier = 0;
uint32_t add_after_mark = 0;
uint32_t extra_options = cb->cx->extra_options;
uint16_t nest_depth = 0;
int after_manual_callout = 0;
int expect_cond_assert = 0;
int errorcode = 0;
int escape;
int i;
BOOL inescq = FALSE;
BOOL inverbname = FALSE;
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
BOOL auto_callout = (options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0;
BOOL isdupname;
BOOL negate_class;
BOOL okquantifier = FALSE;
PCRE2_SPTR thisptr;
PCRE2_SPTR name;
PCRE2_SPTR ptrend = cb->end_pattern;
PCRE2_SPTR verbnamestart = NULL; /* Value avoids compiler warning */
named_group *ng;
nest_save *top_nest, *end_nests;
/* Insert leading items for word and line matching (features provided for the
benefit of pcre2grep). */
if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE) != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_CIRCUMFLEX;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
}
else if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
}
/* If the pattern is actually a literal string, process it separately to avoid
cluttering up the main loop. */
if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) != 0)
{
while (ptr < ptrend)
{
if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end)
{
errorcode = ERR63; /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */
goto FAILED;
}
thisptr = ptr;
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
if (auto_callout)
parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout,
auto_callout, parsed_pattern, cb);
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
}
goto PARSED_END;
}
/* Process a real regex which may contain meta-characters. */
top_nest = NULL;
end_nests = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size);
/* The size of the nest_save structure might not be a factor of the size of the
workspace. Therefore we must round down end_nests so as to correctly avoid
creating a nest_save that spans the end of the workspace. */
end_nests = (nest_save *)((char *)end_nests -
((cb->workspace_size * sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)) % sizeof(nest_save)));
/* PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE implies PCRE2_EXTENDED */
if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0) options |= PCRE2_EXTENDED;
/* Now scan the pattern */
while (ptr < ptrend)
{
int prev_expect_cond_assert;
uint32_t min_repeat = 0, max_repeat = 0;
uint32_t set, unset, *optset;
uint32_t terminator;
uint32_t prev_meta_quantifier;
BOOL prev_okquantifier;
PCRE2_SPTR tempptr;
PCRE2_SIZE offset;
if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end)
{
errorcode = ERR63; /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */
goto FAILED;
}
if (nest_depth > cb->cx->parens_nest_limit)
{
errorcode = ERR19;
goto FAILED; /* Parentheses too deeply nested */
}
/* Get next input character, save its position for callout handling. */
thisptr = ptr;
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
/* Copy quoted literals until \E, allowing for the possibility of automatic
callouts, except when processing a (*VERB) "name". */
if (inescq)
{
if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E)
{
inescq = FALSE;
ptr++; /* Skip E */
}
else
{
if (expect_cond_assert > 0) /* A literal is not allowed if we are */
{ /* expecting a conditional assertion, */
ptr--; /* but an empty \Q\E sequence is OK. */
errorcode = ERR28;
goto FAILED;
}
if (inverbname)
{ /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 /* sets okquantifier. */
if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE;
#endif
*parsed_pattern++ = c;
}
else
{
if (after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout,
auto_callout, parsed_pattern, cb);
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
}
meta_quantifier = 0;
}
continue; /* Next character */
}
/* If we are processing the "name" part of a (*VERB:NAME) item, all
characters up to the closing parenthesis are literals except when
PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES is set. That causes backslash interpretation, but only \Q
and \E and escaped characters are allowed (no character types such as \d). If
PCRE2_EXTENDED is also set, we must ignore white space and # comments. Do
this by not entering the special (*VERB:NAME) processing - they are then
picked up below. Note that c is a character, not a code unit, so we must not
use MAX_255 to test its size because MAX_255 tests code units and is assumed
TRUE in 8-bit mode. */
if (inverbname &&
(
/* EITHER: not both options set */
((options & (PCRE2_EXTENDED | PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES)) !=
(PCRE2_EXTENDED | PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES)) ||
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
/* OR: character > 255 AND not Unicode Pattern White Space */
(c > 255 && (c|1) != 0x200f && (c|1) != 0x2029) ||
#endif
/* OR: not a # comment or isspace() white space */
(c < 256 && c != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) == 0
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
/* and not CHAR_NEL when Unicode is supported */
&& c != CHAR_NEL
#endif
)))
{
PCRE2_SIZE verbnamelength;
switch(c)
{
default: /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 /* sets okquantifier. */
if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE;
#endif
*parsed_pattern++ = c;
break;
case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
inverbname = FALSE;
/* This is the length in characters */
verbnamelength = (PCRE2_SIZE)(parsed_pattern - verblengthptr - 1);
/* But the limit on the length is in code units */
if (ptr - verbnamestart - 1 > (int)MAX_MARK)
{
ptr--;
errorcode = ERR76;
goto FAILED;
}
*verblengthptr = (uint32_t)verbnamelength;
/* If this name was on a verb such as (*ACCEPT) which does not continue,
a (*MARK) was generated for the name. We now add the original verb as the
next item. */
if (add_after_mark != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = add_after_mark;
add_after_mark = 0;
}
break;
case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
if ((options & PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES) != 0)
{
escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options,
cb->cx->extra_options, FALSE, cb);
if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED;
}
else escape = 0; /* Treat all as literal */
switch(escape)
{
case 0: /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 /* sets okquantifier. */
if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE;
#endif
*parsed_pattern++ = c;
break;
case ESC_Q:
inescq = TRUE;
break;
case ESC_E: /* Ignore */
break;
default:
errorcode = ERR40; /* Invalid in verb name */
goto FAILED;
}
}
continue; /* Next character in pattern */
}
/* Not a verb name character. At this point we must process everything that
must not change the quantification state. This is mainly comments, but we
handle \Q and \E here as well, so that an item such as A\Q\E+ is treated as
A+, as in Perl. An isolated \E is ignored. */
if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend)
{
if (*ptr == CHAR_Q || *ptr == CHAR_E)
{
inescq = *ptr == CHAR_Q;
ptr++;
continue;
}
}
/* Skip over whitespace and # comments in extended mode. Note that c is a
character, not a code unit, so we must not use MAX_255 to test its size
because MAX_255 tests code units and is assumed TRUE in 8-bit mode. The
whitespace characters are those designated as "Pattern White Space" by
Unicode, which are the isspace() characters plus CHAR_NEL (newline), which is
U+0085 in Unicode, plus U+200E, U+200F, U+2028, and U+2029. These are a
subset of space characters that match \h and \v. */
if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED) != 0)
{
if (c < 256 && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) continue;
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (c == CHAR_NEL || (c|1) == 0x200f || (c|1) == 0x2029) continue;
#endif
if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
{
while (ptr < ptrend)
{
if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr)) /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
{ /* IS_NEWLINE sets cb->nllen. */
ptr += cb->nllen;
break;
}
ptr++;
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (utf) FORWARDCHARTEST(ptr, ptrend);
#endif
}
continue; /* Next character in pattern */
}
}
/* Skip over bracketed comments */
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptrend - ptr >= 2 &&
ptr[0] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[1] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
{
while (++ptr < ptrend && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS);
if (ptr >= ptrend)
{
errorcode = ERR18; /* A special error for missing ) in a comment */
goto FAILED; /* to make it easier to debug. */
}
ptr++;
continue; /* Next character in pattern */
}
/* If the next item is not a quantifier, fill in length of any previous
callout and create an auto callout if required. */
if (c != CHAR_ASTERISK && c != CHAR_PLUS && c != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
(c != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET ||
(tempptr = ptr,
!read_repeat_counts(&tempptr, ptrend, NULL, NULL, &errorcode))))
{
if (after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout, auto_callout,
parsed_pattern, cb);
}
/* If expect_cond_assert is 2, we have just passed (?( and are expecting an
assertion, possibly preceded by a callout. If the value is 1, we have just
had the callout and expect an assertion. There must be at least 3 more
characters in all cases. When expect_cond_assert is 2, we know that the
current character is an opening parenthesis, as otherwise we wouldn't be
here. However, when it is 1, we need to check, and it's easiest just to check
always. Note that expect_cond_assert may be negative, since all callouts just
decrement it. */
if (expect_cond_assert > 0)
{
BOOL ok = c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptrend - ptr >= 3 &&
(ptr[0] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK);
if (ok)
{
if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK) /* New alpha assertion format, possibly */
{
ok = MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cb->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_lcletter) != 0;
}
else switch(ptr[1]) /* Traditional symbolic format */
{
case CHAR_C:
ok = expect_cond_assert == 2;
break;
case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:
case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:
break;
case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:
ok = ptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || ptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK;
break;
default:
ok = FALSE;
}
}
if (!ok)
{
ptr--; /* Adjust error offset */
errorcode = ERR28;
goto FAILED;
}
}
/* Remember whether we are expecting a conditional assertion, and set the
default for this item. */
prev_expect_cond_assert = expect_cond_assert;
expect_cond_assert = 0;
/* Remember quantification status for the previous significant item, then set
default for this item. */
prev_okquantifier = okquantifier;
prev_meta_quantifier = meta_quantifier;
okquantifier = FALSE;
meta_quantifier = 0;
/* If the previous significant item was a quantifier, adjust the parsed code
if there is a following modifier. The base meta value is always followed by
the PLUS and QUERY values, in that order. We do this here rather than after
reading a quantifier so that intervening comments and /x whitespace can be
ignored without having to replicate code. */
if (prev_meta_quantifier != 0 && (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || c == CHAR_PLUS))
{
parsed_pattern[(prev_meta_quantifier == META_MINMAX)? -3 : -1] =
prev_meta_quantifier + ((c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)?
0x00020000u : 0x00010000u);
continue; /* Next character in pattern */
}
/* Process the next item in the main part of a pattern. */
switch(c)
{
default: /* Non-special character */
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
break;
/* ---- Escape sequence ---- */
case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
tempptr = ptr;
escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options,
cb->cx->extra_options, FALSE, cb);
if (errorcode != 0)
{
ESCAPE_FAILED:
if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL) == 0)
goto FAILED;
ptr = tempptr;
if (ptr >= ptrend) c = CHAR_BACKSLASH; else
{
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */
}
escape = 0; /* Treat as literal character */
}
/* The escape was a data escape or literal character. */
if (escape == 0)
{
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
}
/* The escape was a back (or forward) reference. We keep the offset in
order to give a more useful diagnostic for a bad forward reference. For
references to groups numbered less than 10 we can't use more than two items
in parsed_pattern because they may be just two characters in the input (and
in a 64-bit world an offset may need two elements). So for them, the offset
of the first occurrent is held in a special vector. */
else if (escape < 0)
{
offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 1);
escape = -escape;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_BACKREF | (uint32_t)escape;
if (escape < 10)
{
if (cb->small_ref_offset[escape] == PCRE2_UNSET)
cb->small_ref_offset[escape] = offset;
}
else
{
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
}
okquantifier = TRUE;
}
/* The escape was a character class such as \d etc. or other special
escape indicator such as \A or \X. Most of them generate just a single
parsed item, but \P and \p are followed by a 16-bit type and a 16-bit
value. They are supported only when Unicode is available. The type and
value are packed into a single 32-bit value so that the whole sequences
uses only two elements in the parsed_vector. This is because the same
coding is used if \d (for example) is turned into \p{Nd} when PCRE2_UCP is
set.
There are also some cases where the escape sequence is followed by a name:
\k{name}, \k<name>, and \k'name' are backreferences by name, and \g<name>
and \g'name' are subroutine calls by name; \g{name} is a synonym for
\k{name}. Note that \g<number> and \g'number' are handled by check_escape()
and returned as a negative value (handled above). A name is coded as an
offset into the pattern and a length. */
else switch (escape)
{
case ESC_C:
#ifdef NEVER_BACKSLASH_C
errorcode = ERR85;
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
#else
if ((options & PCRE2_NEVER_BACKSLASH_C) != 0)
{
errorcode = ERR83;
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
}
#endif
okquantifier = TRUE;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
break;
case ESC_X:
#ifndef SUPPORT_UNICODE
errorcode = ERR45; /* Supported only with Unicode support */
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
#endif
case ESC_H:
case ESC_h:
case ESC_N:
case ESC_R:
case ESC_V:
case ESC_v:
okquantifier = TRUE;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
break;
default: /* \A, \B, \b, \G, \K, \Z, \z cannot be quantified. */
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
break;
/* Escapes that change in UCP mode. Note that PCRE2_UCP will never be set
without Unicode support because it is checked when pcre2_compile() is
called. */
case ESC_d:
case ESC_D:
case ESC_s:
case ESC_S:
case ESC_w:
case ESC_W:
okquantifier = TRUE;
if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
}
else
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE +
((escape == ESC_d || escape == ESC_s || escape == ESC_w)?
ESC_p : ESC_P);
switch(escape)
{
case ESC_d:
case ESC_D:
*parsed_pattern++ = (PT_PC << 16) | ucp_Nd;
break;
case ESC_s:
case ESC_S:
*parsed_pattern++ = PT_SPACE << 16;
break;
case ESC_w:
case ESC_W:
*parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16;
break;
}
}
break;
/* Unicode property matching */
case ESC_P:
case ESC_p:
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
{
BOOL negated;
uint16_t ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, &errorcode, cb))
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
if (negated) escape = (escape == ESC_P)? ESC_p : ESC_P;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
*parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pdata;
okquantifier = TRUE;
}
#else
errorcode = ERR45;
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
#endif
break; /* End \P and \p */
/* When \g is used with quotes or angle brackets as delimiters, it is a
numerical or named subroutine call, and control comes here. When used
with brace delimiters it is a numberical back reference and does not come
here because check_escape() returns it directly as a reference. \k is
always a named back reference. */
case ESC_g:
case ESC_k:
if (ptr >= ptrend || (*ptr != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
*ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN && *ptr != CHAR_APOSTROPHE))
{
errorcode = (escape == ESC_g)? ERR57 : ERR69;
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
}
terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)?
CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
/* For a non-braced \g, check for a numerical recursion. */
if (escape == ESC_g && terminator != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1;
if (read_number(&p, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &i,
&errorcode))
{
if (p >= ptrend || *p != terminator)
{
errorcode = ERR57;
goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
}
ptr = p;
goto SET_RECURSION;
}
if (errorcode != 0) goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
}
/* Not a numerical recursion */
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen,
&errorcode, cb)) goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
/* \k and \g when used with braces are back references, whereas \g used
with quotes or angle brackets is a recursion */
*parsed_pattern++ =
(escape == ESC_k || terminator == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)?
META_BACKREF_BYNAME : META_RECURSE_BYNAME;
*parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
okquantifier = TRUE;
break; /* End special escape processing */
}
break; /* End escape sequence processing */
/* ---- Single-character special items ---- */
case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT:
*parsed_pattern++ = META_CIRCUMFLEX;
break;
case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN:
*parsed_pattern++ = META_DOLLAR;
break;
case CHAR_DOT:
*parsed_pattern++ = META_DOT;
okquantifier = TRUE;
break;
/* ---- Single-character quantifiers ---- */
case CHAR_ASTERISK:
meta_quantifier = META_ASTERISK;
goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER;
case CHAR_PLUS:
meta_quantifier = META_PLUS;
goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER;
case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK:
meta_quantifier = META_QUERY;
goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER;
/* ---- Potential {n,m} quantifier ---- */
case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET:
if (!read_repeat_counts(&ptr, ptrend, &min_repeat, &max_repeat,
&errorcode))
{
if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED; /* Error in quantifier. */
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); /* Not a quantifier */
break; /* No more quantifier processing */
}
meta_quantifier = META_MINMAX;
/* Fall through */
/* ---- Quantifier post-processing ---- */
/* Check that a quantifier is allowed after the previous item. */
CHECK_QUANTIFIER:
if (!prev_okquantifier)
{
errorcode = ERR9;
goto FAILED_BACK;
}
/* Most (*VERB)s are not allowed to be quantified, but an ungreedy
quantifier can be useful for (*ACCEPT) - meaning "succeed on backtrack", a
sort of negated (*COMMIT). We therefore allow (*ACCEPT) to be quantified by
wrapping it in non-capturing brackets, but we have to allow for a preceding
(*MARK) for when (*ACCEPT) has an argument. */
if (parsed_pattern[-1] == META_ACCEPT)
{
uint32_t *p;
for (p = parsed_pattern - 1; p >= verbstartptr; p--) p[1] = p[0];
*verbstartptr = META_NOCAPTURE;
parsed_pattern[1] = META_KET;
parsed_pattern += 2;
}
/* Now we can put the quantifier into the parsed pattern vector. At this
stage, we have only the basic quantifier. The check for a following + or ?
modifier happens at the top of the loop, after any intervening comments
have been removed. */
*parsed_pattern++ = meta_quantifier;
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = min_repeat;
*parsed_pattern++ = max_repeat;
}
break;
/* ---- Character class ---- */
case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
okquantifier = TRUE;
/* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is
used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal
sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced
by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are
erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */
if (ptrend - ptr >= 6 &&
(PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0 ||
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0))
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b;
if (ptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD;
}
else
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKBEHIND;
*has_lookbehind = TRUE;
/* The offset is used only for the "non-fixed length" error; this won't
occur here, so just store zero. */
PUTOFFSET((PCRE2_SIZE)0, parsed_pattern);
}
if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_w;
else
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_p;
*parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
ptr += 6;
break;
}
/* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if
they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */
if (ptr < ptrend && (*ptr == CHAR_COLON || *ptr == CHAR_DOT ||
*ptr == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
check_posix_syntax(ptr, ptrend, &tempptr))
{
errorcode = (*ptr-- == CHAR_COLON)? ERR12 : ERR13;
goto FAILED;
}
/* Process a regular character class. If the first character is '^', set
the negation flag. If the first few characters (either before or after ^)
are \Q\E or \E or space or tab in extended-more mode, we skip them too.
This makes for compatibility with Perl. */
negate_class = FALSE;
while (ptr < ptrend)
{
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
{
if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E) ptr++;
else if (ptrend - ptr >= 3 &&
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0)
ptr += 3;
else
break;
}
else if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0 &&
(c == CHAR_SPACE || c == CHAR_HT)) /* Note: just these two */
continue;
else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
negate_class = TRUE;
else break;
}
/* Now the real contents of the class; c has the first "real" character.
Empty classes are permitted only if the option is set. */
if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
(cb->external_options & PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS) != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = negate_class? META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT : META_CLASS_EMPTY;
break; /* End of class processing */
}
/* Process a non-empty class. */
*parsed_pattern++ = negate_class? META_CLASS_NOT : META_CLASS;
class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
/* In an EBCDIC environment, Perl treats alphabetic ranges specially
because there are holes in the encoding, and simply using the range A-Z
(for example) would include the characters in the holes. This applies only
to ranges where both values are literal; [\xC1-\xE9] is different to [A-Z]
in this respect. In order to accommodate this, we keep track of whether
character values are literal or not, and a state variable for handling
ranges. */
/* Loop for the contents of the class */
for (;;)
{
BOOL char_is_literal = TRUE;
/* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */
if (inescq)
{
if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E)
{
inescq = FALSE; /* Reset literal state */
ptr++; /* Skip the 'E' */
goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
}
goto CLASS_LITERAL;
}
/* Skip over space and tab (only) in extended-more mode. */
if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0 &&
(c == CHAR_SPACE || c == CHAR_HT))
goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
/* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the
form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is
treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions
[.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl
5.6 and 5.8 do. */
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
ptrend - ptr >= 3 &&
(*ptr == CHAR_COLON || *ptr == CHAR_DOT ||
*ptr == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
check_posix_syntax(ptr, ptrend, &tempptr))
{
BOOL posix_negate = FALSE;
int posix_class;
/* Perl treats a hyphen before a POSIX class as a literal, not the
start of a range. However, it gives a warning in its warning mode. PCRE
does not have a warning mode, so we give an error, because this is
likely an error on the user's part. */
if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
{
errorcode = ERR50;
goto FAILED;
}
if (*ptr != CHAR_COLON)
{
errorcode = ERR13;
goto FAILED_BACK;
}
if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
{
posix_negate = TRUE;
ptr++;
}
posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr));
if (posix_class < 0)
{
errorcode = ERR30;
goto FAILED;
}
ptr = tempptr + 2;
/* Perl treats a hyphen after a POSIX class as a literal, not the
start of a range. However, it gives a warning in its warning mode
unless the hyphen is the last character in the class. PCRE does not
have a warning mode, so we give an error, because this is likely an
error on the user's part. */
if (ptr < ptrend - 1 && *ptr == CHAR_MINUS &&
ptr[1] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
{
errorcode = ERR50;
goto FAILED;
}
/* Set "a hyphen is not the start of a range" for the -] case, and also
in case the POSIX class is followed by \E or \Q\E (possibly repeated -
fuzzers do that kind of thing) and *then* a hyphen. This causes that
hyphen to be treated as a literal. I don't think it's worth setting up
special apparatus to do otherwise. */
class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
/* When PCRE2_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
use Unicode properties \p or \P or, in one case, \h or \H. The
substitutes table has two values per class, containing the type and
value of a \p or \P item. The special cases are specified with a
negative type: a non-zero value causes \h or \H to be used, and a zero
value falls through to behave like a non-UCP POSIX class. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0)
{
int ptype = posix_substitutes[2*posix_class];
int pvalue = posix_substitutes[2*posix_class + 1];
if (ptype >= 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + (posix_negate? ESC_P : ESC_p);
*parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pvalue;
goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
}
if (pvalue != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + (posix_negate? ESC_H : ESC_h);
goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
}
/* Fall through */
}
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/* Non-UCP POSIX class */
*parsed_pattern++ = posix_negate? META_POSIX_NEG : META_POSIX;
*parsed_pattern++ = posix_class;
}
/* Handle potential start of range */
else if (c == CHAR_MINUS && class_range_state >= RANGE_OK_ESCAPED)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = (class_range_state == RANGE_OK_LITERAL)?
META_RANGE_LITERAL : META_RANGE_ESCAPED;
class_range_state = RANGE_STARTED;
}
/* Handle a literal character */
else if (c != CHAR_BACKSLASH)
{
CLASS_LITERAL:
if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
{
if (c == parsed_pattern[-2]) /* Optimize one-char range */
parsed_pattern--;
else if (parsed_pattern[-2] > c) /* Check range is in order */
{
errorcode = ERR8;
goto FAILED_BACK;
}
else
{
if (!char_is_literal && parsed_pattern[-1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL)
parsed_pattern[-1] = META_RANGE_ESCAPED;
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
}
class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
}
else /* Potential start of range */
{
class_range_state = char_is_literal?
RANGE_OK_LITERAL : RANGE_OK_ESCAPED;
PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
}
}
/* Handle escapes in a class */
else
{
tempptr = ptr;
escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options,
cb->cx->extra_options, TRUE, cb);
if (errorcode != 0)
{
if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL) == 0)
goto FAILED;
ptr = tempptr;
if (ptr >= ptrend) c = CHAR_BACKSLASH; else
{
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */
}
escape = 0; /* Treat as literal character */
}
switch(escape)
{
case 0: /* Escaped character code point is in c */
char_is_literal = FALSE;
goto CLASS_LITERAL;
case ESC_b:
c = CHAR_BS; /* \b is backspace in a class */
char_is_literal = FALSE;
goto CLASS_LITERAL;
case ESC_Q:
inescq = TRUE; /* Enter literal mode */
goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
case ESC_E: /* Ignore orphan \E */
goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
case ESC_B: /* Always an error in a class */
case ESC_R:
case ESC_X:
errorcode = ERR7;
ptr--;
goto FAILED;
}
/* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape
sequence (detected above), but not any of the other escapes. Perl
treats a hyphen as a literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's
warning mode, a warning is given, so PCRE now faults it, as it is
almost certainly a mistake on the user's part. */
if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
{
errorcode = ERR50;
goto FAILED; /* Not CLASS_ESCAPE_FAILED; always an error */
}
/* Of the remaining escapes, only those that define characters are
allowed in a class. None may start a range. */
class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
switch(escape)
{
case ESC_N:
errorcode = ERR71;
goto FAILED;
case ESC_H:
case ESC_h:
case ESC_V:
case ESC_v:
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
break;
/* These escapes are converted to Unicode property tests when
PCRE2_UCP is set. */
case ESC_d:
case ESC_D:
case ESC_s:
case ESC_S:
case ESC_w:
case ESC_W:
if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
}
else
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE +
((escape == ESC_d || escape == ESC_s || escape == ESC_w)?
ESC_p : ESC_P);
switch(escape)
{
case ESC_d:
case ESC_D:
*parsed_pattern++ = (PT_PC << 16) | ucp_Nd;
break;
case ESC_s:
case ESC_S:
*parsed_pattern++ = PT_SPACE << 16;
break;
case ESC_w:
case ESC_W:
*parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16;
break;
}
}
break;
/* Explicit Unicode property matching */
case ESC_P:
case ESC_p:
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
{
BOOL negated;
uint16_t ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, &errorcode, cb))
goto FAILED;
if (negated) escape = (escape == ESC_P)? ESC_p : ESC_P;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
*parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pdata;
}
#else
errorcode = ERR45;
goto FAILED;
#endif
break; /* End \P and \p */
default: /* All others are not allowed in a class */
errorcode = ERR7;
ptr--;
goto FAILED;
}
/* Perl gives a warning unless a following hyphen is the last character
in the class. PCRE throws an error. */
if (ptr < ptrend - 1 && *ptr == CHAR_MINUS &&
ptr[1] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
{
errorcode = ERR50;
goto FAILED;
}
}
/* Proceed to next thing in the class. */
CLASS_CONTINUE:
if (ptr >= ptrend)
{
errorcode = ERR6; /* Missing terminating ']' */
goto FAILED;
}
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET && !inescq) break;
} /* End of class-processing loop */
/* -] at the end of a class is a literal '-' */
if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
{
parsed_pattern[-1] = CHAR_MINUS;
class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = META_CLASS_END;
break; /* End of character class */
/* ---- Opening parenthesis ---- */
case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
if (ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
/* If ( is not followed by ? it is either a capture or a special verb or an
alpha assertion or a positive non-atomic lookahead. */
if (*ptr != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
{
const char *vn;
/* Handle capturing brackets (or non-capturing if auto-capture is turned
off). */
if (*ptr != CHAR_ASTERISK)
{
nest_depth++;
if ((options & PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) == 0)
{
if (cb->bracount >= MAX_GROUP_NUMBER)
{
errorcode = ERR97;
goto FAILED;
}
cb->bracount++;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_CAPTURE | cb->bracount;
}
else *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
}
/* Do nothing for (* followed by end of pattern or ) so it gives a "bad
quantifier" error rather than "(*MARK) must have an argument". */
else if (ptrend - ptr <= 1 || (c = ptr[1]) == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
break;
/* Handle "alpha assertions" such as (*pla:...). Most of these are
synonyms for the historical symbolic assertions, but the script run and
non-atomic lookaround ones are new. They are distinguished by starting
with a lower case letter. Checking both ends of the alphabet makes this
work in all character codes. */
else if (CHMAX_255(c) && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_lcletter) != 0)
{
uint32_t meta;
vn = alasnames;
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, 0, &offset, &name, &namelen,
&errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
{
errorcode = ERR95; /* Malformed */
goto FAILED;
}
/* Scan the table of alpha assertion names */
for (i = 0; i < alascount; i++)
{
if (namelen == alasmeta[i].len &&
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
break;
vn += alasmeta[i].len + 1;
}
if (i >= alascount)
{
errorcode = ERR95; /* Alpha assertion not recognized */
goto FAILED;
}
/* Check for expecting an assertion condition. If so, only atomic
lookaround assertions are valid. */
meta = alasmeta[i].meta;
if (prev_expect_cond_assert > 0 &&
(meta < META_LOOKAHEAD || meta > META_LOOKBEHINDNOT))
{
errorcode = (meta == META_LOOKAHEAD_NA || meta == META_LOOKBEHIND_NA)?
ERR98 : ERR28; /* (Atomic) assertion expected */
goto FAILED;
}
/* The lookaround alphabetic synonyms can mostly be handled by jumping
to the code that handles the traditional symbolic forms. */
switch(meta)
{
default:
errorcode = ERR89; /* Unknown code; should never occur because */
goto FAILED; /* the meta values come from a table above. */
case META_ATOMIC:
goto ATOMIC_GROUP;
case META_LOOKAHEAD:
goto POSITIVE_LOOK_AHEAD;
case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
goto POSITIVE_NONATOMIC_LOOK_AHEAD;
case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
goto NEGATIVE_LOOK_AHEAD;
case META_LOOKBEHIND:
case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
*parsed_pattern++ = meta;
ptr--;
goto POST_LOOKBEHIND;
/* The script run facilities are handled here. Unicode support is
required (give an error if not, as this is a security issue). Always
record a META_SCRIPT_RUN item. Then, for the atomic version, insert
META_ATOMIC and remember that we need two META_KETs at the end. */
case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
case META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN:
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
*parsed_pattern++ = META_SCRIPT_RUN;
nest_depth++;
ptr++;
if (meta == META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ATOMIC;
if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace);
else if (++top_nest >= end_nests)
{
errorcode = ERR84;
goto FAILED;
}
top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
top_nest->flags = NSF_ATOMICSR;
top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS;
}
break;
#else /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
errorcode = ERR96;
goto FAILED;
#endif
}
}
/* ---- Handle (*VERB) and (*VERB:NAME) ---- */
else
{
vn = verbnames;
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, 0, &offset, &name, &namelen,
&errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
if (ptr >= ptrend || (*ptr != CHAR_COLON &&
*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS))
{
errorcode = ERR60; /* Malformed */
goto FAILED;
}
/* Scan the table of verb names */
for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++)
{
if (namelen == verbs[i].len &&
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
break;
vn += verbs[i].len + 1;
}
if (i >= verbcount)
{
errorcode = ERR60; /* Verb not recognized */
goto FAILED;
}
/* An empty argument is treated as no argument. */
if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON && ptr + 1 < ptrend &&
ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
ptr++; /* Advance to the closing parens */
/* Check for mandatory non-empty argument; this is (*MARK) */
if (verbs[i].has_arg > 0 && *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
{
errorcode = ERR66;
goto FAILED;
}
/* Remember where this verb, possibly with a preceding (*MARK), starts,
for handling quantified (*ACCEPT). */
verbstartptr = parsed_pattern;
okquantifier = (verbs[i].meta == META_ACCEPT);
/* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than a
closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments ("names"), so we no longer
insist on letters, digits, and underscores. Perl does not, however, do
any interpretation within arguments, and has no means of including a
closing parenthesis. PCRE supports escape processing but only when it
is requested by an option. We set inverbname TRUE here, and let the
main loop take care of this so that escape and \x processing is done by
the main code above. */
if (*ptr++ == CHAR_COLON) /* Skip past : or ) */
{
/* Some optional arguments can be treated as a preceding (*MARK) */
if (verbs[i].has_arg < 0)
{
add_after_mark = verbs[i].meta;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_MARK;
}
/* The remaining verbs with arguments (except *MARK) need a different
opcode. */
else
{
*parsed_pattern++ = verbs[i].meta +
((verbs[i].meta != META_MARK)? 0x00010000u:0);
}
/* Set up for reading the name in the main loop. */
verblengthptr = parsed_pattern++;
verbnamestart = ptr;
inverbname = TRUE;
}
else /* No verb "name" argument */
{
*parsed_pattern++ = verbs[i].meta;
}
} /* End of (*VERB) handling */
break; /* Done with this parenthesis */
} /* End of groups that don't start with (? */
/* ---- Items starting (? ---- */
/* The type of item is determined by what follows (?. Handle (?| and option
changes under "default" because both need a new block on the nest stack.
Comments starting with (?# are handled above. Note that there is some
ambiguity about the sequence (?- because if a digit follows it's a relative
recursion or subroutine call whereas otherwise it's an option unsetting. */
if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
switch(*ptr)
{
default:
if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS && ptrend - ptr > 1 && IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
goto RECURSION_BYNUMBER; /* The + case is handled by CHAR_PLUS */
/* We now have either (?| or a (possibly empty) option setting,
optionally followed by a non-capturing group. */
nest_depth++;
if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace);
else if (++top_nest >= end_nests)
{
errorcode = ERR84;
goto FAILED;
}
top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
top_nest->flags = 0;
top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS;
/* Start of non-capturing group that resets the capture count for each
branch. */
if (*ptr == CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE)
{
top_nest->reset_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount;
top_nest->max_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount;
top_nest->flags |= NSF_RESET;
cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
ptr++;
}
/* Scan for options imnsxJU to be set or unset. */
else
{
BOOL hyphenok = TRUE;
uint32_t oldoptions = options;
top_nest->reset_group = 0;
top_nest->max_group = 0;
set = unset = 0;
optset = &set;
/* ^ at the start unsets imnsx and disables the subsequent use of - */
if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
{
options &= ~(PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE|
PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE);
hyphenok = FALSE;
ptr++;
}
while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS &&
*ptr != CHAR_COLON)
{
switch (*ptr++)
{
case CHAR_MINUS:
if (!hyphenok)
{
errorcode = ERR94;
ptr--; /* Correct the offset */
goto FAILED;
}
optset = &unset;
hyphenok = FALSE;
break;
case CHAR_J: /* Record that it changed in the external options */
*optset |= PCRE2_DUPNAMES;
cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_JCHANGED;
break;
case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE2_CASELESS; break;
case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE2_MULTILINE; break;
case CHAR_n: *optset |= PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE; break;
case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE2_DOTALL; break;
case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE2_UNGREEDY; break;
/* If x appears twice it sets the extended extended option. */
case CHAR_x:
*optset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED;
if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_x)
{
*optset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE;
ptr++;
}
break;
default:
errorcode = ERR11;
ptr--; /* Correct the offset */
goto FAILED;
}
}
/* If we are setting extended without extended-more, ensure that any
existing extended-more gets unset. Also, unsetting extended must also
unset extended-more. */
if ((set & (PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE)) == PCRE2_EXTENDED ||
(unset & PCRE2_EXTENDED) != 0)
unset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE;
options = (options | set) & (~unset);
/* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested
group with option changes, so the options change at this level.
In this case, if the previous level set up a nest block, discard the
one we have just created. Otherwise adjust it for the previous level.
If the options ended with ':' we are starting a non-capturing group,
possibly with an options setting. */
if (ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
if (*ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
nest_depth--; /* This is not a nested group after all. */
if (top_nest > (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace) &&
(top_nest-1)->nest_depth == nest_depth) top_nest--;
else top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
}
else *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
/* If nothing changed, no need to record. */
if (options != oldoptions)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_OPTIONS;
*parsed_pattern++ = options;
}
} /* End options processing */
break; /* End default case after (? */
/* ---- Python syntax support ---- */
case CHAR_P:
if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
/* (?P<name> is the same as (?<name>, which defines a named group. */
if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
{
terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
goto DEFINE_NAME;
}
/* (?P>name) is the same as (?&name), which is a recursion or subroutine
call. */
if (*ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN) goto RECURSE_BY_NAME;
/* (?P=name) is the same as \k<name>, a back reference by name. Anything
else after (?P is an error. */
if (*ptr != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN)
{
errorcode = ERR41;
goto FAILED;
}
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, &offset, &name,
&namelen, &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_BACKREF_BYNAME;
*parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
okquantifier = TRUE;
break; /* End of (?P processing */
/* ---- Recursion/subroutine calls by number ---- */
case CHAR_R:
i = 0; /* (?R) == (?R0) */
ptr++;
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
errorcode = ERR58;
goto FAILED;
}
goto SET_RECURSION;
/* An item starting (?- followed by a digit comes here via the "default"
case because (?- followed by a non-digit is an options setting. */
case CHAR_PLUS:
if (ptrend - ptr < 2 || !IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
{
errorcode = ERR29; /* Missing number */
goto FAILED;
}
/* Fall through */
case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4:
case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
RECURSION_BYNUMBER:
if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend,
(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))? -1:(int)(cb->bracount), /* + and - are relative */
MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61,
&i, &errorcode)) goto FAILED;
if (i < 0) /* NB (?0) is permitted */
{
errorcode = ERR15; /* Unknown group */
goto FAILED_BACK;
}
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
SET_RECURSION:
*parsed_pattern++ = META_RECURSE | (uint32_t)i;
offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
ptr++;
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
okquantifier = TRUE;
break; /* End of recursive call by number handling */
/* ---- Recursion/subroutine calls by name ---- */
case CHAR_AMPERSAND:
RECURSE_BY_NAME:
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, &offset, &name,
&namelen, &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_RECURSE_BYNAME;
*parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
okquantifier = TRUE;
break;
/* ---- Callout with numerical or string argument ---- */
case CHAR_C:
if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
/* If the previous item was a condition starting (?(? an assertion,
optionally preceded by a callout, is expected. This is checked later on,
during actual compilation. However we need to identify this kind of
assertion in this pass because it must not be qualified. The value of
expect_cond_assert is set to 2 after (?(? is processed. We decrement it
for a callout - still leaving a positive value that identifies the
assertion. Multiple callouts or any other items will make it zero or
less, which doesn't matter because they will cause an error later. */
expect_cond_assert = prev_expect_cond_assert - 1;
/* If previous_callout is not NULL, it means this follows a previous
callout. If it was a manual callout, do nothing; this means its "length
of next pattern item" field will remain zero. If it was an automatic
callout, abolish it. */
if (previous_callout != NULL && (options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 &&
previous_callout == parsed_pattern - 4 &&
parsed_pattern[-1] == 255)
parsed_pattern = previous_callout;
/* Save for updating next pattern item length, and skip one item before
completing. */
previous_callout = parsed_pattern;
after_manual_callout = 1;
/* Handle a string argument; specific delimiter is required. */
if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && !IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
{
PCRE2_SIZE calloutlength;
PCRE2_SPTR startptr = ptr;
delimiter = 0;
for (i = 0; PRIV(callout_start_delims)[i] != 0; i++)
{
if (*ptr == PRIV(callout_start_delims)[i])
{
delimiter = PRIV(callout_end_delims)[i];
break;
}
}
if (delimiter == 0)
{
errorcode = ERR82;
goto FAILED;
}
*parsed_pattern = META_CALLOUT_STRING;
parsed_pattern += 3; /* Skip pattern info */
for (;;)
{
if (++ptr >= ptrend)
{
errorcode = ERR81;
ptr = startptr; /* To give a more useful message */
goto FAILED;
}
if (*ptr == delimiter && (++ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != delimiter))
break;
}
calloutlength = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - startptr);
if (calloutlength > UINT32_MAX)
{
errorcode = ERR72;
goto FAILED;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = (uint32_t)calloutlength;
offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(startptr - cb->start_pattern);
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
}
/* Handle a callout with an optional numerical argument, which must be
less than or equal to 255. A missing argument gives 0. */
else
{
int n = 0;
*parsed_pattern = META_CALLOUT_NUMBER; /* Numerical callout */
parsed_pattern += 3; /* Skip pattern info */
while (ptr < ptrend && IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
{
n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
if (n > 255)
{
errorcode = ERR38;
goto FAILED;
}
}
*parsed_pattern++ = n;
}
/* Both formats must have a closing parenthesis */
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
errorcode = ERR39;
goto FAILED;
}
ptr++;
/* Remember the offset to the next item in the pattern, and set a default
length. This should get updated after the next item is read. */
previous_callout[1] = (uint32_t)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
previous_callout[2] = 0;
break; /* End callout */
/* ---- Conditional group ---- */
/* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered
group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R',
referring to overall recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted
for recursion state tests. Numbers may be preceded by + or - to specify a
relative group number.
There are several syntaxes for testing a named group: (?(name)) is used
by Python; Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')).
There are two unfortunate ambiguities. 'R' can be the recursive thing or
the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by digits). 'DEFINE' can be
the Perl DEFINE feature or the Python named test. We look for a name
first; if not found, we try the other case.
For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be specified
before a condition that is an assertion. */
case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
nest_depth++;
/* If the next character is ? or * there must be an assertion next
(optionally preceded by a callout). We do not check this here, but
instead we set expect_cond_assert to 2. If this is still greater than
zero (callouts decrement it) when the next assertion is read, it will be
marked as a condition that must not be repeated. A value greater than
zero also causes checking that an assertion (possibly with callout)
follows. */
if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || *ptr == CHAR_ASTERISK)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_ASSERT;
ptr--; /* Pull pointer back to the opening parenthesis. */
expect_cond_assert = 2;
break; /* End of conditional */
}
/* Handle (?([+-]number)... */
if (read_number(&ptr, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &i,
&errorcode))
{
if (i <= 0)
{
errorcode = ERR15;
goto FAILED;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_NUMBER;
offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 2);
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
*parsed_pattern++ = i;
}
else if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED; /* Number too big */
/* No number found. Handle the special case (?(VERSION[>]=n.m)... */
else if (ptrend - ptr >= 10 &&
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_VERSION, 7) == 0 &&
ptr[7] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
uint32_t ge = 0;
int major = 0;
int minor = 0;
ptr += 7;
if (*ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN)
{
ge = 1;
ptr++;
}
/* NOTE: cannot write IS_DIGIT(*(++ptr)) here because IS_DIGIT
references its argument twice. */
if (*ptr != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || (ptr++, !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)))
goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, -1, 1000, ERR79, &major, &errorcode))
goto FAILED;
if (ptr >= ptrend) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
if (*ptr == CHAR_DOT)
{
if (++ptr >= ptrend || !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
minor = (*ptr++ - CHAR_0) * 10;
if (ptr >= ptrend) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) minor += *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_VERSION;
*parsed_pattern++ = ge;
*parsed_pattern++ = major;
*parsed_pattern++ = minor;
}
/* All the remaining cases now require us to read a name. We cannot at
this stage distinguish ambiguous cases such as (?(R12) which might be a
recursion test by number or a name, because the named groups have not yet
all been identified. Those cases are treated as names, but given a
different META code. */
else
{
BOOL was_r_ampersand = FALSE;
if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptrend - ptr > 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND)
{
terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
was_r_ampersand = TRUE;
ptr++;
}
else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
else
{
terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
ptr--; /* Point to char before name */
}
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen,
&errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
/* Handle (?(R&name) */
if (was_r_ampersand)
{
*parsed_pattern = META_COND_RNAME;
ptr--; /* Back to closing parens */
}
/* Handle (?(name). If the name is "DEFINE" we identify it with a
special code. Likewise if the name consists of R followed only by
digits. Otherwise, handle it like a quoted name. */
else if (terminator == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
if (namelen == 6 && PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0)
*parsed_pattern = META_COND_DEFINE;
else
{
for (i = 1; i < (int)namelen; i++)
if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i])) break;
*parsed_pattern = (*name == CHAR_R && i >= (int)namelen)?
META_COND_RNUMBER : META_COND_NAME;
}
ptr--; /* Back to closing parens */
}
/* Handle (?('name') or (?(<name>) */
else *parsed_pattern = META_COND_NAME;
/* All these cases except DEFINE end with the name length and offset;
DEFINE just has an offset (for the "too many branches" error). */
if (*parsed_pattern++ != META_COND_DEFINE) *parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
} /* End cases that read a name */
/* Check the closing parenthesis of the condition */
if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
errorcode = ERR24;
goto FAILED;
}
ptr++;
break; /* End of condition processing */
/* ---- Atomic group ---- */
case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN:
ATOMIC_GROUP: /* Come from (*atomic: */
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ATOMIC;
nest_depth++;
ptr++;
break;
/* ---- Lookahead assertions ---- */
case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:
POSITIVE_LOOK_AHEAD: /* Come from (*pla: */
*parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD;
ptr++;
goto POST_ASSERTION;
case CHAR_ASTERISK:
POSITIVE_NONATOMIC_LOOK_AHEAD: /* Come from (?* */
*parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD_NA;
ptr++;
goto POST_ASSERTION;
case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:
NEGATIVE_LOOK_AHEAD: /* Come from (*nla: */
*parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEADNOT;
ptr++;
goto POST_ASSERTION;
/* ---- Lookbehind assertions ---- */
/* (?< followed by = or ! or * is a lookbehind assertion. Otherwise (?<
is the start of the name of a capturing group. */
case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:
if (ptrend - ptr <= 1 ||
(ptr[1] != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN &&
ptr[1] != CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK &&
ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK))
{
terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
goto DEFINE_NAME;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = (ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN)?
META_LOOKBEHIND : (ptr[1] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK)?
META_LOOKBEHINDNOT : META_LOOKBEHIND_NA;
POST_LOOKBEHIND: /* Come from (*plb: (*naplb: and (*nlb: */
*has_lookbehind = TRUE;
offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 2);
PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
ptr += 2;
/* Fall through */
/* If the previous item was a condition starting (?(? an assertion,
optionally preceded by a callout, is expected. This is checked later on,
during actual compilation. However we need to identify this kind of
assertion in this pass because it must not be qualified. The value of
expect_cond_assert is set to 2 after (?(? is processed. We decrement it
for a callout - still leaving a positive value that identifies the
assertion. Multiple callouts or any other items will make it zero or
less, which doesn't matter because they will cause an error later. */
POST_ASSERTION:
nest_depth++;
if (prev_expect_cond_assert > 0)
{
if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace);
else if (++top_nest >= end_nests)
{
errorcode = ERR84;
goto FAILED;
}
top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
top_nest->flags = NSF_CONDASSERT;
top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS;
}
break;
/* ---- Define a named group ---- */
/* A named group may be defined as (?'name') or (?<name>). In the latter
case we jump to DEFINE_NAME from the disambiguation of (?< above with the
terminator set to '>'. */
case CHAR_APOSTROPHE:
terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE; /* Terminator */
DEFINE_NAME:
if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen,
&errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
/* We have a name for this capturing group. It is also assigned a number,
which is its primary means of identification. */
if (cb->bracount >= MAX_GROUP_NUMBER)
{
errorcode = ERR97;
goto FAILED;
}
cb->bracount++;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_CAPTURE | cb->bracount;
nest_depth++;
/* Check not too many names */
if (cb->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT)
{
errorcode = ERR49;
goto FAILED;
}
/* Adjust the entry size to accommodate the longest name found. */
if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cb->name_entry_size)
cb->name_entry_size = (uint16_t)(namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1);
/* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the
number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be
discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error.
If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue
scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For
non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */
isdupname = FALSE;
ng = cb->named_groups;
for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
{
if (namelen == ng->length &&
PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, (PCRE2_SIZE)namelen) == 0)
{
if (ng->number == cb->bracount) break;
if ((options & PCRE2_DUPNAMES) == 0)
{
errorcode = ERR43;
goto FAILED;
}
isdupname = ng->isdup = TRUE; /* Mark as a duplicate */
cb->dupnames = TRUE; /* Duplicate names exist */
}
else if (ng->number == cb->bracount)
{
errorcode = ERR65;
goto FAILED;
}
}
if (i < cb->names_found) break; /* Ignore duplicate with same number */
/* Increase the list size if necessary */
if (cb->names_found >= cb->named_group_list_size)
{
uint32_t newsize = cb->named_group_list_size * 2;
named_group *newspace =
cb->cx->memctl.malloc(newsize * sizeof(named_group),
cb->cx->memctl.memory_data);
if (newspace == NULL)
{
errorcode = ERR21;
goto FAILED;
}
memcpy(newspace, cb->named_groups,
cb->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group));
if (cb->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
cb->cx->memctl.free((void *)cb->named_groups,
cb->cx->memctl.memory_data);
cb->named_groups = newspace;
cb->named_group_list_size = newsize;
}
/* Add this name to the list */
cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].name = name;
cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].length = (uint16_t)namelen;
cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].number = cb->bracount;
cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].isdup = (uint16_t)isdupname;
cb->names_found++;
break;
} /* End of (? switch */
break; /* End of ( handling */
/* ---- Branch terminators ---- */
/* Alternation: reset the capture count if we are in a (?| group. */
case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:
if (top_nest != NULL && top_nest->nest_depth == nest_depth &&
(top_nest->flags & NSF_RESET) != 0)
{
if (cb->bracount > top_nest->max_group)
top_nest->max_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount;
cb->bracount = top_nest->reset_group;
}
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ALT;
break;
/* End of group; reset the capture count to the maximum if we are in a (?|
group and/or reset the options that are tracked during parsing. Disallow
quantifier for a condition that is an assertion. */
case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
okquantifier = TRUE;
if (top_nest != NULL && top_nest->nest_depth == nest_depth)
{
options = (options & ~PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS) | top_nest->options;
if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_RESET) != 0 &&
top_nest->max_group > cb->bracount)
cb->bracount = top_nest->max_group;
if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_CONDASSERT) != 0)
okquantifier = FALSE;
if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_ATOMICSR) != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
}
if (top_nest == (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace)) top_nest = NULL;
else top_nest--;
}
if (nest_depth == 0) /* Unmatched closing parenthesis */
{
errorcode = ERR22;
goto FAILED_BACK;
}
nest_depth--;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
break;
} /* End of switch on pattern character */
} /* End of main character scan loop */
/* End of pattern reached. Check for missing ) at the end of a verb name. */
if (inverbname && ptr >= ptrend)
{
errorcode = ERR60;
goto FAILED;
}
/* Manage callout for the final item */
PARSED_END:
parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(ptr, &previous_callout, auto_callout,
parsed_pattern, cb);
/* Insert trailing items for word and line matching (features provided for the
benefit of pcre2grep). */
if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE) != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_DOLLAR;
}
else if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) != 0)
{
*parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
*parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b;
}
/* Terminate the parsed pattern, then return success if all groups are closed.
Otherwise we have unclosed parentheses. */
if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end)
{
errorcode = ERR63; /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */
goto FAILED;
}
*parsed_pattern = META_END;
if (nest_depth == 0) return 0;
UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS:
errorcode = ERR14;
/* Come here for all failures. */
FAILED:
cb->erroroffset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
return errorcode;
/* Some errors need to indicate the previous character. */
FAILED_BACK:
ptr--;
goto FAILED;
/* This failure happens several times. */
BAD_VERSION_CONDITION:
errorcode = ERR79;
goto FAILED;
}
/*************************************************
* Find first significant opcode *
*************************************************/
/* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking
for a fixed first character, or an anchoring opcode etc. It skips over things
that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative
forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it
does not.
Arguments:
code pointer to the start of the group
skipassert TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped
Returns: pointer to the first significant opcode
*/
static const PCRE2_UCHAR*
first_significant_code(PCRE2_SPTR code, BOOL skipassert)
{
for (;;)
{
switch ((int)*code)
{
case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
case OP_ASSERTBACK:
case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
case OP_ASSERTBACK_NA:
if (!skipassert) return code;
do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
break;
case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
if (!skipassert) return code;
/* Fall through */
case OP_CALLOUT:
case OP_CREF:
case OP_DNCREF:
case OP_RREF:
case OP_DNRREF:
case OP_FALSE:
case OP_TRUE:
code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
break;
case OP_CALLOUT_STR:
code += GET(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
break;
case OP_SKIPZERO:
code += 2 + GET(code, 2) + LINK_SIZE;
break;
case OP_COND:
case OP_SCOND:
if (code[1+LINK_SIZE] != OP_FALSE || /* Not DEFINE */
code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_KET) /* More than one branch */
return code;
code += GET(code, 1) + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
break;
case OP_MARK:
case OP_COMMIT_ARG:
case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
case OP_SKIP_ARG:
case OP_THEN_ARG:
code += code[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
break;
default:
return code;
}
}
/* Control never reaches here */
}
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
/*************************************************
* Get othercase range *
*************************************************/
/* This function is passed the start and end of a class range in UCP mode. It
searches up the characters, looking for ranges of characters in the "other"
case. Each call returns the next one, updating the start address. A character
with multiple other cases is returned on its own with a special return value.
Arguments:
cptr points to starting character value; updated
d end value
ocptr where to put start of othercase range
odptr where to put end of othercase range
Yield: -1 when no more
0 when a range is returned
>0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases
in this case, ocptr contains the original
*/
static int
get_othercase_range(uint32_t *cptr, uint32_t d, uint32_t *ocptr,
uint32_t *odptr)
{
uint32_t c, othercase, next;
unsigned int co;
/* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other
cases, return its case offset value. */
for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++)
{
if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
{
*ocptr = c++; /* Character that has the set */
*cptr = c; /* Rest of input range */
return (int)co;
}
if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break;
}
if (c > d) return -1; /* Reached end of range */
/* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the
range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero
or more than one other cases. */
*ocptr = othercase;
next = othercase + 1;
for (++c; c <= d; c++)
{
if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break;
next++;
}
*odptr = next - 1; /* End of othercase range */
*cptr = c; /* Rest of input range */
return 0;
}
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/*************************************************
* Add a character or range to a class (internal) *
*************************************************/
/* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of
characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the
valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is
called only from within the "add to class" group of functions, some of which
are recursive and mutually recursive. The external entry point is
add_to_class().
Arguments:
classbits the bit map for characters < 256
uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data
options the options word
cb compile data
start start of range character
end end of range character
Returns: the number of < 256 characters added
the pointer to extra data is updated
*/
static unsigned int
add_to_class_internal(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr,
uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, uint32_t start, uint32_t end)
{
uint32_t c;
uint32_t classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
unsigned int n8 = 0;
/* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate
cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that
are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original
range. */
if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)
{
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((options & (PCRE2_UTF|PCRE2_UCP)) != 0)
{
int rc;
uint32_t oc, od;
options &= ~PCRE2_CASELESS; /* Remove for recursive calls */
c = start;
while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0)
{
/* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */
if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb,
PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc);
/* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */
else if (oc >= cb->class_range_start && od <= cb->class_range_end) continue;
/* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we
can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic
range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */
else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */
else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1)
{
end = od; /* Extend upwards */
if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
}
else n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, oc, od);
}
}
else
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/* Not UTF mode */
for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
{
SETBIT(classbits, cb->fcc[c]);
n8++;
}
}
/* Now handle the originally supplied range. Adjust the final value according
to the bit length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces
can be used in all cases. */
if ((options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 && end > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR)
end = MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR;
if (start > cb->class_range_start && end < cb->class_range_end) return n8;
/* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/
for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
{
/* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */
SETBIT(classbits, c);
n8++;
}
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1;
if (end >= start)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *uchardata = *uchardptr;
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0)
{
if (start < end)
{
*uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata);
}
else if (start == end)
{
*uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
}
}
else
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length,
and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
{}
#else
if (start < end)
{
*uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
*uchardata++ = start;
*uchardata++ = end;
}
else if (start == end)
{
*uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
*uchardata++ = start;
}
#endif /* PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 */
*uchardptr = uchardata; /* Updata extra data pointer */
}
#else /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */
(void)uchardptr; /* Avoid compiler warning */
#endif /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */
return n8; /* Number of 8-bit characters */
}
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
/*************************************************
* Add a list of characters to a class (internal) *
*************************************************/
/* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a
class when in UTF mode. This function is called only from within
add_to_class_internal(), with which it is mutually recursive.
Arguments:
classbits the bit map for characters < 256
uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data
options the options word
cb contains pointers to tables etc.
p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
except character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
already know about
Returns: the number of < 256 characters added
the pointer to extra data is updated
*/
static unsigned int
add_list_to_class_internal(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr,
uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p, unsigned int except)
{
unsigned int n8 = 0;
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
{
unsigned int n = 0;
if (p[0] != except)
{
while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0], p[n]);
}
p += n + 1;
}
return n8;
}
#endif
/*************************************************
* External entry point for add range to class *
*************************************************/
/* This function sets the overall range so that the internal functions can try
to avoid duplication when handling case-independence.
Arguments:
classbits the bit map for characters < 256
uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data
options the options word
cb compile data
start start of range character
end end of range character
Returns: the number of < 256 characters added
the pointer to extra data is updated
*/
static unsigned int
add_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, uint32_t options,
compile_block *cb, uint32_t start, uint32_t end)
{
cb->class_range_start = start;
cb->class_range_end = end;
return add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, start, end);
}
/*************************************************
* External entry point for add list to class *
*************************************************/
/* This function is used for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace
characters to a class. The list must be in order so that ranges of characters
can be detected and handled appropriately. This function sets the overall range
so that the internal functions can try to avoid duplication when handling
case-independence.
Arguments:
classbits the bit map for characters < 256
uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data
options the options word
cb contains pointers to tables etc.
p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
except character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
already know about
Returns: the number of < 256 characters added
the pointer to extra data is updated
*/
static unsigned int
add_list_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, uint32_t options,
compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p, unsigned int except)
{
unsigned int n8 = 0;
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
{
unsigned int n = 0;
if (p[0] != except)
{
while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
cb->class_range_start = p[0];
cb->class_range_end = p[n];
n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0], p[n]);
}
p += n + 1;
}
return n8;
}
/*************************************************
* Add characters not in a list to a class *
*************************************************/
/* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or
vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order.
Arguments:
classbits the bit map for characters < 256
uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data
options the options word
cb contains pointers to tables etc.
p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
Returns: the number of < 256 characters added
the pointer to extra data is updated
*/
static unsigned int
add_not_list_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr,
uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p)
{
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
unsigned int n8 = 0;
if (p[0] > 0)
n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, 0, p[0] - 1);
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
{
while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++;
n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0] + 1,
(p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1);
p++;
}
return n8;
}
/*************************************************
* Find details of duplicate group names *
*************************************************/
/* This is called from compile_branch() when it needs to know the index and
count of duplicates in the names table when processing named backreferences,
either directly, or as conditions.
Arguments:
name points to the name
length the length of the name
indexptr where to put the index
countptr where to put the count of duplicates
errorcodeptr where to put an error code
cb the compile block
Returns: TRUE if OK, FALSE if not, error code set
*/
static BOOL
find_dupname_details(PCRE2_SPTR name, uint32_t length, int *indexptr,
int *countptr, int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb)
{
uint32_t i, groupnumber;
int count;
PCRE2_UCHAR *slot = cb->name_table;
/* Find the first entry in the table */
for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++)
{
if (PRIV(strncmp)(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, length) == 0 &&
slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] == 0) break;
slot += cb->name_entry_size;
}
/* This should not occur, because this function is called only when we know we
have duplicate names. Give an internal error. */
if (i >= cb->names_found)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR53;
cb->erroroffset = name - cb->start_pattern;
return FALSE;
}
/* Record the index and then see how many duplicates there are, updating the
backref map and maximum back reference as we do. */
*indexptr = i;
count = 0;
for (;;)
{
count++;
groupnumber = GET2(slot,0);
cb->backref_map |= (groupnumber < 32)? (1u << groupnumber) : 1;
if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = groupnumber;
if (++i >= cb->names_found) break;
slot += cb->name_entry_size;
if (PRIV(strncmp)(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, length) != 0 ||
(slot+IMM2_SIZE)[length] != 0) break;
}
*countptr = count;
return TRUE;
}
/*************************************************
* Compile one branch *
*************************************************/
/* Scan the parsed pattern, compiling it into the a vector of PCRE2_UCHAR. If
the options are changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the
external options bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when
we are trying to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the
real compile phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
Arguments:
optionsptr pointer to the option bits
codeptr points to the pointer to the current code point
pptrptr points to the current parsed pattern pointer
errorcodeptr points to error code variable
firstcuptr place to put the first required code unit
firstcuflagsptr place to put the first code unit flags
reqcuptr place to put the last required code unit
reqcuflagsptr place to put the last required code unit flags
bcptr points to current branch chain
cb contains pointers to tables etc.
lengthptr NULL during the real compile phase
points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
Returns: 0 There's been an error, *errorcodeptr is non-zero
+1 Success, this branch must match at least one character
-1 Success, this branch may match an empty string
*/
static int
compile_branch(uint32_t *optionsptr, PCRE2_UCHAR **codeptr, uint32_t **pptrptr,
int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t *firstcuptr, uint32_t *firstcuflagsptr,
uint32_t *reqcuptr, uint32_t *reqcuflagsptr, branch_chain *bcptr,
compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SIZE *lengthptr)
{
int bravalue = 0;
int okreturn = -1;
int group_return = 0;
uint32_t repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0; /* To please picky compilers */
uint32_t greedy_default, greedy_non_default;
uint32_t repeat_type, op_type;
uint32_t options = *optionsptr; /* May change dynamically */
uint32_t firstcu, reqcu;
uint32_t zeroreqcu, zerofirstcu;
uint32_t escape;
uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr;
uint32_t meta, meta_arg;
uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags;
uint32_t zeroreqcuflags, zerofirstcuflags;
uint32_t req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary;
PCRE2_SIZE offset = 0;
PCRE2_SIZE length_prevgroup = 0;
PCRE2_UCHAR *code = *codeptr;
PCRE2_UCHAR *last_code = code;
PCRE2_UCHAR *orig_code = code;
PCRE2_UCHAR *tempcode;
PCRE2_UCHAR *previous = NULL;
PCRE2_UCHAR op_previous;
BOOL groupsetfirstcu = FALSE;
BOOL had_accept = FALSE;
BOOL matched_char = FALSE;
BOOL previous_matched_char = FALSE;
BOOL reset_caseful = FALSE;
const uint8_t *cbits = cb->cbits;
uint8_t classbits[32];
/* We can fish out the UTF setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we must
not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE2_EXTENDED) because they may change
dynamically as we process the pattern. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
BOOL ucp = (options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0;
#else /* No Unicode support */
BOOL utf = FALSE;
#endif
/* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define
class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always,
though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply
alternative calls for the different cases. */
PCRE2_UCHAR *class_uchardata;
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
BOOL xclass;
PCRE2_UCHAR *class_uchardata_base;
#endif
/* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */
greedy_default = ((options & PCRE2_UNGREEDY) != 0);
greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
/* Initialize no first unit, no required unit. REQ_UNSET means "no char
matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that
matches a non-fixed first unit; reqcu just remains unset if we never find one.
When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values
to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to
zerofirstcu and zeroreqcu when such a repeat is encountered. The individual
item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */
firstcu = reqcu = zerofirstcu = zeroreqcu = 0;
firstcuflags = reqcuflags = zerofirstcuflags = zeroreqcuflags = REQ_UNSET;
/* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS bit or zero,
according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The REQ_CASELESS value
leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the firstcu or reqcu variables
to record the case status of the value. This is used only for ASCII characters.
*/
req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS : 0;
/* Switch on next META item until the end of the branch */
for (;; pptr++)
{
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
BOOL xclass_has_prop;
#endif
BOOL negate_class;
BOOL should_flip_negation;
BOOL match_all_or_no_wide_chars;
BOOL possessive_quantifier;
BOOL note_group_empty;
int class_has_8bitchar;
uint32_t mclength;
uint32_t skipunits;
uint32_t subreqcu, subfirstcu;
uint32_t groupnumber;
uint32_t verbarglen, verbculen;
uint32_t subreqcuflags, subfirstcuflags;
open_capitem *oc;
PCRE2_UCHAR mcbuffer[8];
/* Get next META item in the pattern and its potential argument. */
meta = META_CODE(*pptr);
meta_arg = META_DATA(*pptr);
/* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the
previous cycle of this loop, unless the next item is a quantifier. */
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
if (code > cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size -
WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN) /* Check for overrun */
{
*errorcodeptr = (code >= cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size)?
ERR52 : ERR86;
return 0;
}
/* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the
case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). When the quantifier
is processed, the whole class is eliminated. However, it is created first,
so we have to allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length
at this point. */
if (code < last_code) code = last_code;
/* If the next thing is not a quantifier, we add the length of the previous
item into the total, and reset the code pointer to the start of the
workspace. Otherwise leave the previous item available to be quantified. */
if (meta < META_ASTERISK || meta > META_MINMAX_QUERY)
{
if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < (PCRE2_SIZE)(code - orig_code))
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20; /* Integer overflow */
return 0;
}
*lengthptr += (PCRE2_SIZE)(code - orig_code);
if (*lengthptr > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20; /* Pattern is too large */
return 0;
}
code = orig_code;
}
/* Remember where this code item starts so we can catch the "backwards"
case above next time round. */
last_code = code;
}
/* Process the next parsed pattern item. If it is not a quantifier, remember
where it starts so that it can be quantified when a quantifier follows.
Checking for the legality of quantifiers happens in parse_regex(), except for
a quantifier after an assertion that is a condition. */
if (meta < META_ASTERISK || meta > META_MINMAX_QUERY)
{
previous = code;
if (matched_char && !had_accept) okreturn = 1;
}
previous_matched_char = matched_char;
matched_char = FALSE;
note_group_empty = FALSE;
skipunits = 0; /* Default value for most subgroups */
switch(meta)
{
/* ===================================================================*/
/* The branch terminates at pattern end or | or ) */
case META_END:
case META_ALT:
case META_KET:
*firstcuptr = firstcu;
*firstcuflagsptr = firstcuflags;
*reqcuptr = reqcu;
*reqcuflagsptr = reqcuflags;
*codeptr = code;
*pptrptr = pptr;
return okreturn;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables
the setting of any following char as a first character. */
case META_CIRCUMFLEX:
if ((options & PCRE2_MULTILINE) != 0)
{
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET)
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
*code++ = OP_CIRCM;
}
else *code++ = OP_CIRC;
break;
case META_DOLLAR:
*code++ = ((options & PCRE2_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL;
break;
/* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about
repeats. The value of reqcu doesn't change either. */
case META_DOT:
matched_char = TRUE;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
*code++ = ((options & PCRE2_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY;
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Empty character classes are allowed if PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS is set.
Otherwise, an initial ']' is taken as a data character. When empty classes
are allowed, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas [^] must
match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */
case META_CLASS_EMPTY:
case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT:
matched_char = TRUE;
*code++ = (meta == META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT)? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Non-empty character class. If the included characters are all < 256, we
build a 32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special
case where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build
the map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different
opcode so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly.
If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different
opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256,
but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag code unit
tells whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or
not. */
case META_CLASS_NOT:
case META_CLASS:
matched_char = TRUE;
negate_class = meta == META_CLASS_NOT;
/* We can optimize the case of a single character in a class by generating
OP_CHAR or OP_CHARI if it's positive, or OP_NOT or OP_NOTI if it's
negative. In the negative case there can be no first char if this item is
first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of reqcu, save the
previous value for reinstating. */
/* NOTE: at present this optimization is not effective if the only
character in a class in 32-bit, non-UCP mode has its top bit set. */
if (pptr[1] < META_END && pptr[2] == META_CLASS_END)
{
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
uint32_t d;
#endif
uint32_t c = pptr[1];
pptr += 2; /* Move on to class end */
if (meta == META_CLASS) /* A positive one-char class can be */
{ /* handled as a normal literal character. */
meta = c; /* Set up the character */
goto NORMAL_CHAR_SET;
}
/* Handle a negative one-character class */
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
/* For caseless UTF or UCP mode, check whether this character has more
than one other case. If so, generate a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of
OP_NOTI. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((utf||ucp) && (options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0 &&
(d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
{
*code++ = OP_NOTPROP;
*code++ = PT_CLIST;
*code++ = d;
break; /* We are finished with this class */
}
#endif
/* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */
*code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT;
code += PUTCHAR(c, code);
break; /* We are finished with this class */
} /* End of 1-char optimization */
/* Handle character classes that contain more than just one literal
character. If there are exactly two characters in a positive class, see if
they are case partners. This can be optimized to generate a caseless single
character match (which also sets first/required code units if relevant). */
if (meta == META_CLASS && pptr[1] < META_END && pptr[2] < META_END &&
pptr[3] == META_CLASS_END)
{
uint32_t c = pptr[1];
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (UCD_CASESET(c) == 0)
#endif
{
uint32_t d;
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((utf || ucp) && c > 127) d = UCD_OTHERCASE(c); else
#endif
{
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH != 8
if (c > 255) d = c; else
#endif
d = TABLE_GET(c, cb->fcc, c);
}
if (c != d && pptr[2] == d)
{
pptr += 3; /* Move on to class end */
meta = c;
if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) == 0)
{
reset_caseful = TRUE;
options |= PCRE2_CASELESS;
req_caseopt = REQ_CASELESS;
}
goto CLASS_CASELESS_CHAR;
}
}
}
/* If a non-extended class contains a negative special such as \S, we need
to flip the negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255
works correctly (they are all included in the class). An extended class may
need to insert specific matching or non-matching code for wide characters.
*/
should_flip_negation = match_all_or_no_wide_chars = FALSE;
/* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255
might match. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
xclass = FALSE;
class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2; /* For XCLASS items */
class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata; /* Save the start */
#endif
/* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class:
class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one
character with a code point less than 256; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if
Unicode property checks are present in the class. */
class_has_8bitchar = 0;
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
xclass_has_prop = FALSE;
#endif
/* Initialize the 256-bit (32-byte) bit map to all zeros. We build the map
in a temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two
8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit
map. */
memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(uint8_t));
/* Process items until META_CLASS_END is reached. */
while ((meta = *(++pptr)) != META_CLASS_END)
{
/* Handle POSIX classes such as [:alpha:] etc. */
if (meta == META_POSIX || meta == META_POSIX_NEG)
{
BOOL local_negate = (meta == META_POSIX_NEG);
int posix_class = *(++pptr);
int taboffset, tabopt;
uint8_t pbits[32];
should_flip_negation = local_negate; /* Note negative special */
/* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to alpha.
This relies on the fact that the class table starts with alpha,
lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */
if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2)
posix_class = 0;
/* When PCRE2_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P.
Others that are not available via \p or \P have to generate
XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP directly, which is done here. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0) switch(posix_class)
{
case PC_GRAPH:
case PC_PRINT:
case PC_PUNCT:
*class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP;
*class_uchardata++ = (PCRE2_UCHAR)
((posix_class == PC_GRAPH)? PT_PXGRAPH :
(posix_class == PC_PRINT)? PT_PXPRINT : PT_PXPUNCT);
*class_uchardata++ = 0;
xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
goto CONTINUE_CLASS;
/* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, xdigit) we are going to
fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for
characters with code points less than 256. However, if we are in
a negated POSIX class, characters with code points greater than
255 must either all match or all not match, depending on whether
the whole class is not or is negated. For example, for
[[:^ascii:]... they must all match, whereas for [^[:^xdigit:]...
they must not.
In the special case where there are no xclass items, this is
automatically handled by the use of OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, but an
explicit range is needed for OP_XCLASS. Setting a flag here
causes the range to be generated later when it is known that
OP_XCLASS is required. In the 8-bit library this is relevant only in
utf mode, since no wide characters can exist otherwise. */
default:
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
if (utf)
#endif
match_all_or_no_wide_chars |= local_negate;
break;
}
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
/* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the
bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may
be adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits
that may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into
the bit map that is being built. */
posix_class *= 3;
/* Copy in the first table (always present) */
memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class],
32 * sizeof(uint8_t));
/* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */
taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1];
tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2];
if (taboffset >= 0)
{
if (tabopt >= 0)
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) pbits[i] |= cbits[(int)i + taboffset];
else
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) pbits[i] &= ~cbits[(int)i + taboffset];
}
/* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option
value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */
if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt;
if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c;
else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f;
/* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is
being built and we are done. */
if (local_negate)
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~pbits[i]);
else
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= pbits[i];
/* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
class_has_8bitchar = 1;
goto CONTINUE_CLASS; /* End of POSIX handling */
}
/* Other than POSIX classes, the only items we should encounter are
\d-type escapes and literal characters (possibly as ranges). */
if (meta == META_BIGVALUE)
{
meta = *(++pptr);
goto CLASS_LITERAL;
}
/* Any other non-literal must be an escape */
if (meta >= META_END)
{
if (META_CODE(meta) != META_ESCAPE)
{
#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
fprintf(stderr, "** Unrecognized parsed pattern item 0x%.8x "
"in character class\n", meta);
#endif
*errorcodeptr = ERR89; /* Internal error - unrecognized. */
return 0;
}
escape = META_DATA(meta);
/* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
class_has_8bitchar++;
switch(escape)
{
case ESC_d:
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_digit];
break;
case ESC_D:
should_flip_negation = TRUE;
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++)
classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_digit]);
break;
case ESC_w:
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_word];
break;
case ESC_W:
should_flip_negation = TRUE;
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++)
classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_word]);
break;
/* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl
5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was
previously set by something earlier in the character class.
Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so
we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no
longer treat \s and \S specially. */
case ESC_s:
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_space];
break;
case ESC_S:
should_flip_negation = TRUE;
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++)
classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_space]);
break;
/* When adding the horizontal or vertical space lists to a class, or
their complements, disable PCRE2_CASELESS, because it justs wastes
time, and in the "not-x" UTF cases can create unwanted duplicates in
the XCLASS list (provoked by characters that have more than one other
case and by both cases being in the same "not-x" sublist). */
case ESC_h:
(void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR);
break;
case ESC_H:
(void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(hspace_list));
break;
case ESC_v:
(void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR);
break;
case ESC_V:
(void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(vspace_list));
break;
/* If Unicode is not supported, \P and \p are not allowed and are
faulted at parse time, so will never appear here. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
case ESC_p:
case ESC_P:
{
uint32_t ptype = *(++pptr) >> 16;
uint32_t pdata = *pptr & 0xffff;
*class_uchardata++ = (escape == ESC_p)? XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP;
*class_uchardata++ = ptype;
*class_uchardata++ = pdata;
xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
class_has_8bitchar--; /* Undo! */
}
break;
#endif
}
goto CONTINUE_CLASS;
} /* End handling \d-type escapes */
/* A literal character may be followed by a range meta. At parse time
there are checks for out-of-order characters, for ranges where the two
characters are equal, and for hyphens that cannot indicate a range. At
this point, therefore, no checking is needed. */
else
{
uint32_t c, d;
CLASS_LITERAL:
c = d = meta;
/* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */
if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF;
/* Process a character range */
if (pptr[1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL || pptr[1] == META_RANGE_ESCAPED)
{
#ifdef EBCDIC
BOOL range_is_literal = (pptr[1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL);
#endif
pptr += 2;
d = *pptr;
if (d == META_BIGVALUE) d = *(++pptr);
/* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */
if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF;
/* In an EBCDIC environment, Perl treats alphabetic ranges specially
because there are holes in the encoding, and simply using the range
A-Z (for example) would include the characters in the holes. This
applies only to literal ranges; [\xC1-\xE9] is different to [A-Z]. */
#ifdef EBCDIC
if (range_is_literal &&
(cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_letter) != 0 &&
(cb->ctypes[d] & ctype_letter) != 0 &&
(c <= CHAR_z) == (d <= CHAR_z))
{
uint32_t uc = (d <= CHAR_z)? 0 : 64;
uint32_t C = c - uc;
uint32_t D = d - uc;
if (C <= CHAR_i)
{
class_has_8bitchar +=
add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc,
((D < CHAR_i)? D : CHAR_i) + uc);
C = CHAR_j;
}
if (C <= D && C <= CHAR_r)
{
class_has_8bitchar +=
add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc,
((D < CHAR_r)? D : CHAR_r) + uc);
C = CHAR_s;
}
if (C <= D)
{
class_has_8bitchar +=
add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc,
D + uc);
}
}
else
#endif
/* Not an EBCDIC special range */
class_has_8bitchar +=
add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, c, d);
goto CONTINUE_CLASS; /* Go get the next char in the class */
} /* End of range handling */
/* Handle a single character. */
class_has_8bitchar +=
add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, meta, meta);
}
/* Continue to the next item in the class. */
CONTINUE_CLASS:
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
/* If any wide characters or Unicode properties have been encountered,
set xclass = TRUE. Then, in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length
of the extra data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large
classes that contain a zillion wide characters or Unicode property tests
do not overwrite the workspace (which is on the stack). */
if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base)
{
xclass = TRUE;
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
*lengthptr += class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base;
class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base;
}
}
#endif
continue; /* Needed to avoid error when not supporting wide chars */
} /* End of main class-processing loop */
/* If this class is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first
char setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqcu setting must remain
unchanged after any kind of repeat. */
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
/* If there are characters with values > 255, or Unicode property settings
(\p or \P), we have to compile an extended class, with its own opcode,
unless there were no property settings and there was a negated special such
as \S in the class, and PCRE2_UCP is not set, because in that case all
characters > 255 are in or not in the class, so any that were explicitly
given as well can be ignored.
In the UCP case, if certain negated POSIX classes ([:^ascii:] or
[^:xdigit:]) were present in a class, we either have to match or not match
all wide characters (depending on whether the whole class is or is not
negated). This requirement is indicated by match_all_or_no_wide_chars being
true. We do this by including an explicit range, which works in both cases.
This applies only in UTF and 16-bit and 32-bit non-UTF modes, since there
cannot be any wide characters in 8-bit non-UTF mode.
When there *are* properties in a positive UTF-8 or any 16-bit or 32_bit
class where \S etc is present without PCRE2_UCP, causing an extended class
to be compiled, we make sure that all characters > 255 are included by
forcing match_all_or_no_wide_chars to be true.
If, when generating an xclass, there are no characters < 256, we can omit
the bitmap in the actual compiled code. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS /* Defined for 16/32 bits, or 8-bit with Unicode */
if (xclass && (
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
(options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0 ||
#endif
xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation))
{
if (match_all_or_no_wide_chars || (
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
utf &&
#endif
should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0))
{
*class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
if (utf) /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */
{
class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT, class_uchardata);
}
else /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */
{
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
*class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
*class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu;
#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
*class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
*class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu;
#endif
}
}
*class_uchardata++ = XCL_END; /* Marks the end of extra data */
*code++ = OP_XCLASS;
code += LINK_SIZE;
*code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0;
if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP;
/* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it;
otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */
if (class_has_8bitchar > 0)
{
*code++ |= XCL_MAP;
(void)memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)), code,
CU2BYTES(class_uchardata - code));
if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop)
{
/* Using 255 ^ instead of ~ avoids clang sanitize warning. */
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] = 255 ^ classbits[i];
}
memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR));
}
else code = class_uchardata;
/* Now fill in the complete length of the item */
PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous));
break; /* End of class handling */
}
#endif /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */
/* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or
excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the
whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S
(non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector,
negating it if necessary. */
*code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS;
if (lengthptr == NULL) /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */
{
if (negate_class)
{
/* Using 255 ^ instead of ~ avoids clang sanitize warning. */
for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] = 255 ^ classbits[i];
}
memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
}
code += 32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR);
break; /* End of class processing */
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Deal with (*VERB)s. */
/* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and close those that are within
the same assertion level, also converting ACCEPT to ASSERT_ACCEPT in an
assertion. In the first pass, just accumulate the length required;
otherwise hitting (*ACCEPT) inside many nested parentheses can cause
workspace overflow. Do not set firstcu after *ACCEPT. */
case META_ACCEPT:
cb->had_accept = had_accept = TRUE;
for (oc = cb->open_caps;
oc != NULL && oc->assert_depth >= cb->assert_depth;
oc = oc->next)
{
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
*lengthptr += CU2BYTES(1) + IMM2_SIZE;
}
else
{
*code++ = OP_CLOSE;
PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number);
}
}
*code++ = (cb->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
break;
case META_PRUNE:
case META_SKIP:
cb->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
/* Fall through */
case META_COMMIT:
case META_FAIL:
*code++ = verbops[(meta - META_MARK) >> 16];
break;
case META_THEN:
cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASTHEN;
*code++ = OP_THEN;
break;
/* Handle verbs with arguments. Arguments can be very long, especially in
16- and 32-bit modes, and can overflow the workspace in the first pass.
However, the argument length is constrained to be small enough to fit in
one code unit. This check happens in parse_regex(). In the first pass,
instead of putting the argument into memory, we just update the length
counter and set up an empty argument. */
case META_THEN_ARG:
cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASTHEN;
goto VERB_ARG;
case META_PRUNE_ARG:
case META_SKIP_ARG:
cb->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
/* Fall through */
case META_MARK:
case META_COMMIT_ARG:
VERB_ARG:
*code++ = verbops[(meta - META_MARK) >> 16];
/* The length is in characters. */
verbarglen = *(++pptr);
verbculen = 0;
tempcode = code++;
for (int i = 0; i < (int)verbarglen; i++)
{
meta = *(++pptr);
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (utf) mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(meta, mcbuffer); else
#endif
{
mclength = 1;
mcbuffer[0] = meta;
}
if (lengthptr != NULL) *lengthptr += mclength; else
{
memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
code += mclength;
verbculen += mclength;
}
}
*tempcode = verbculen; /* Fill in the code unit length */
*code++ = 0; /* Terminating zero */
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle options change. The new setting must be passed back for use in
subsequent branches. Reset the greedy defaults and the case value for
firstcu and reqcu. */
case META_OPTIONS:
*optionsptr = options = *(++pptr);
greedy_default = ((options & PCRE2_UNGREEDY) != 0);
greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS : 0;
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle conditional subpatterns. The case of (?(Rdigits) is ambiguous
because it could be a numerical check on recursion, or a name check on a
group's being set. The pre-pass sets up META_COND_RNUMBER as a name so that
we can handle it either way. We first try for a name; if not found, process
the number. */
case META_COND_RNUMBER: /* (?(Rdigits) */
case META_COND_NAME: /* (?(name) or (?'name') or ?(<name>) */
case META_COND_RNAME: /* (?(R&name) - test for recursion */
bravalue = OP_COND;
{
int count, index;
unsigned int i;
PCRE2_SPTR name;
named_group *ng = cb->named_groups;
uint32_t length = *(++pptr);
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
name = cb->start_pattern + offset;
/* In the first pass, the names generated in the pre-pass are available,
but the main name table has not yet been created. Scan the list of names
generated in the pre-pass in order to get a number and whether or not
this name is duplicated. If it is not duplicated, we can handle it as a
numerical group. */
for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
{
if (length == ng->length &&
PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0)
{
if (!ng->isdup)
{
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (meta == META_COND_RNAME)? OP_RREF : OP_CREF;
PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, ng->number);
if (ng->number > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = ng->number;
skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
}
break; /* Found a duplicated name */
}
}
/* If the name was not found we have a bad reference, unless we are
dealing with R<digits>, which is treated as a recursion test by number.
*/
if (i >= cb->names_found)
{
groupnumber = 0;
if (meta == META_COND_RNUMBER)
{
for (i = 1; i < length; i++)
{
groupnumber = groupnumber * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0;
if (groupnumber > MAX_GROUP_NUMBER)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR61;
cb->erroroffset = offset + i;
return 0;
}
}
}
if (meta != META_COND_RNUMBER || groupnumber > cb->bracount)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR15;
cb->erroroffset = offset;
return 0;
}
/* (?Rdigits) treated as a recursion reference by number. A value of
zero (which is the result of both (?R) and (?R0)) means "any", and is
translated into RREF_ANY (which is 0xffff). */
if (groupnumber == 0) groupnumber = RREF_ANY;
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;
PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, groupnumber);
skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
}
/* A duplicated name was found. Note that if an R<digits> name is found
(META_COND_RNUMBER), it is a reference test, not a recursion test. */
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (meta == META_COND_RNAME)? OP_RREF : OP_CREF;
/* We have a duplicated name. In the compile pass we have to search the
main table in order to get the index and count values. */
count = 0; /* Values for first pass (avoids compiler warning) */
index = 0;
if (lengthptr == NULL && !find_dupname_details(name, length, &index,
&count, errorcodeptr, cb)) return 0;
/* Add one to the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and
insert appropriate data values. */
code[1+LINK_SIZE]++;
skipunits = 1+2*IMM2_SIZE;
PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, index);
PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count);
}
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
/* The DEFINE condition is always false. Its internal groups may never
be called, so matched_char must remain false, hence the jump to
GROUP_PROCESS rather than GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY. */
case META_COND_DEFINE:
bravalue = OP_COND;
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEFINE;
skipunits = 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
/* Conditional test of a group's being set. */
case META_COND_NUMBER:
bravalue = OP_COND;
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
groupnumber = *(++pptr);
if (groupnumber > cb->bracount)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR15;
cb->erroroffset = offset;
return 0;
}
if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = groupnumber;
offset -= 2; /* Point at initial ( for too many branches error */
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF;
skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, groupnumber);
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
/* Test for the PCRE2 version. */
case META_COND_VERSION:
bravalue = OP_COND;
if (pptr[1] > 0)
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = ((PCRE2_MAJOR > pptr[2]) ||
(PCRE2_MAJOR == pptr[2] && PCRE2_MINOR >= pptr[3]))?
OP_TRUE : OP_FALSE;
else
code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (PCRE2_MAJOR == pptr[2] && PCRE2_MINOR == pptr[3])?
OP_TRUE : OP_FALSE;
skipunits = 1;
pptr += 3;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
/* The condition is an assertion, possibly preceded by a callout. */
case META_COND_ASSERT:
bravalue = OP_COND;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle all kinds of nested bracketed groups. The non-capturing,
non-conditional cases are here; others come to GROUP_PROCESS via goto. */
case META_LOOKAHEAD:
bravalue = OP_ASSERT;
cb->assert_depth += 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NA;
cb->assert_depth += 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
/* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird
thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when
they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for
this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow
it for uniformity. */
case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
if (pptr[1] == META_KET &&
(pptr[2] < META_ASTERISK || pptr[2] > META_MINMAX_QUERY))
{
*code++ = OP_FAIL;
pptr++;
}
else
{
bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT;
cb->assert_depth += 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
}
break;
case META_LOOKBEHIND:
bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK;
cb->assert_depth += 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT;
cb->assert_depth += 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NA;
cb->assert_depth += 1;
goto GROUP_PROCESS;
case META_ATOMIC:
bravalue = OP_ONCE;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
bravalue = OP_SCRIPT_RUN;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
case META_NOCAPTURE:
bravalue = OP_BRA;
/* Fall through */
/* Process nested bracketed regex. The nesting depth is maintained for the
benefit of the stackguard function. The test for too deep nesting is now
done in parse_regex(). Assertion and DEFINE groups come to GROUP_PROCESS;
others come to GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY, to indicate that we need to take
note of whether or not they may match an empty string. */
GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY:
note_group_empty = TRUE;
GROUP_PROCESS:
cb->parens_depth += 1;
*code = bravalue;
pptr++;
tempcode = code;
tempreqvary = cb->req_varyopt; /* Save value before group */
length_prevgroup = 0; /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */
if ((group_return =
compile_regex(
options, /* The option state */
&tempcode, /* Where to put code (updated) */
&pptr, /* Input pointer (updated) */
errorcodeptr, /* Where to put an error message */
skipunits, /* Skip over bracket number */
&subfirstcu, /* For possible first char */
&subfirstcuflags,
&subreqcu, /* For possible last char */
&subreqcuflags,
bcptr, /* Current branch chain */
cb, /* Compile data block */
(lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : /* Actual compile phase */
&length_prevgroup /* Pre-compile phase */
)) == 0)
return 0; /* Error */
cb->parens_depth -= 1;
/* If that was a non-conditional significant group (not an assertion, not a
DEFINE) that matches at least one character, then the current item matches
a character. Conditionals are handled below. */
if (note_group_empty && bravalue != OP_COND && group_return > 0)
matched_char = TRUE;
/* If we've just compiled an assertion, pop the assert depth. */
if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NA)
cb->assert_depth -= 1;
/* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the
group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group.
The parsed pattern pointer (pptr) is on the closing META_KET.
If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than
two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this
in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may
not be available. */
if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *tc = code;
int condcount = 0;
do {
condcount++;
tc += GET(tc,1);
}
while (*tc != OP_KET);
/* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always
false). It must have only one branch. Having checked this, change the
opcode to OP_FALSE. */
if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEFINE)
{
if (condcount > 1)
{
cb->erroroffset = offset;
*errorcodeptr = ERR54;
return 0;
}
code[LINK_SIZE+1] = OP_FALSE;
bravalue = OP_DEFINE; /* A flag to suppress char handling below */
}
/* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not
make use of its firstcu or reqcu, because this is equivalent to an
empty second branch. Also, it may match an empty string. If there are two
branches, this item must match a character if the group must. */
else
{
if (condcount > 2)
{
cb->erroroffset = offset;
*errorcodeptr = ERR27;
return 0;
}
if (condcount == 1) subfirstcuflags = subreqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
else if (group_return > 0) matched_char = TRUE;
}
}
/* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group,
less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a
set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is
duplicated by a quantifier.*/
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20;
return 0;
}
*lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;
code++; /* This already contains bravalue */
PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
*code++ = OP_KET;
PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
break; /* No need to waste time with special character handling */
}
/* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */
code = tempcode;
/* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not
relevant. */
if (bravalue == OP_DEFINE) break;
/* Handle updating of the required and first code units for other types of
group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two
branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with
zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqcu and
zerofirstcu outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the back
off. */
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
groupsetfirstcu = FALSE;
if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE) /* Not an assertion */
{
/* If we have not yet set a firstcu in this branch, take it from the
subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more
than one can replicate it as reqcu if necessary. If the subpattern has
no firstcu, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero
repeat forces firstcu to "none". */
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET && subfirstcuflags != REQ_UNSET)
{
if (subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
{
firstcu = subfirstcu;
firstcuflags = subfirstcuflags;
groupsetfirstcu = TRUE;
}
else firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
}
/* If firstcu was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstcu
into reqcu if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in
existence beforehand. */
else if (subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE && subreqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
{
subreqcu = subfirstcu;
subreqcuflags = subfirstcuflags | tempreqvary;
}
/* If the subpattern set a required code unit (or set a first code unit
that isn't really the first code unit - see above), set it. */
if (subreqcuflags < REQ_NONE)
{
reqcu = subreqcu;
reqcuflags = subreqcuflags;
}
}
/* For a forward assertion, we take the reqcu, if set, provided that the
group has also set a firstcu. This can be helpful if the pattern that
follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's
useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstcu for an assertion, however
because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when
the "real" "a" would then become a reqcu instead of a firstcu. This is
overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstcu, looking for an
asserted first char. A similar effect for patterns like /(?=.*X)X$/ means
we must only take the reqcu when the group also set a firstcu. Otherwise,
in that example, 'X' ends up set for both. */
else if ((bravalue == OP_ASSERT || bravalue == OP_ASSERT_NA) &&
subreqcuflags < REQ_NONE && subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
{
reqcu = subreqcu;
reqcuflags = subreqcuflags;
}
break; /* End of nested group handling */
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle named backreferences and recursions. */
case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
{
int count, index;
PCRE2_SPTR name;
BOOL is_dupname = FALSE;
named_group *ng = cb->named_groups;
uint32_t length = *(++pptr);
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
name = cb->start_pattern + offset;
/* In the first pass, the names generated in the pre-pass are available,
but the main name table has not yet been created. Scan the list of names
generated in the pre-pass in order to get a number and whether or not
this name is duplicated. */
groupnumber = 0;
for (unsigned int i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
{
if (length == ng->length &&
PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0)
{
is_dupname = ng->isdup;
groupnumber = ng->number;
/* For a recursion, that's all that is needed. We can now go to
the code that handles numerical recursion, applying it to the first
group with the given name. */
if (meta == META_RECURSE_BYNAME)
{
meta_arg = groupnumber;
goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION;
}
/* For a back reference, update the back reference map and the
maximum back reference. */
cb->backref_map |= (groupnumber < 32)? (1u << groupnumber) : 1;
if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref)
cb->top_backref = groupnumber;
}
}
/* If the name was not found we have a bad reference. */
if (groupnumber == 0)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR15;
cb->erroroffset = offset;
return 0;
}
/* If a back reference name is not duplicated, we can handle it as
a numerical reference. */
if (!is_dupname)
{
meta_arg = groupnumber;
goto HANDLE_SINGLE_REFERENCE;
}
/* If a back reference name is duplicated, we generate a different
opcode to a numerical back reference. In the second pass we must
search for the index and count in the final name table. */
count = 0; /* Values for first pass (avoids compiler warning) */
index = 0;
if (lengthptr == NULL && !find_dupname_details(name, length, &index,
&count, errorcodeptr, cb)) return 0;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
*code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF;
PUT2INC(code, 0, index);
PUT2INC(code, 0, count);
}
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle a numerical callout. */
case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
code[0] = OP_CALLOUT;
PUT(code, 1, pptr[1]); /* Offset to next pattern item */
PUT(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE, pptr[2]); /* Length of next pattern item */
code[1 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = pptr[3];
pptr += 3;
code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle a callout with a string argument. In the pre-pass we just compute
the length without generating anything. The length in pptr[3] includes both
delimiters; in the actual compile only the first one is copied, but a
terminating zero is added. Any doubled delimiters within the string make
this an overestimate, but it is not worth bothering about. */
case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
*lengthptr += pptr[3] + (1 + 4*LINK_SIZE);
pptr += 3;
SKIPOFFSET(pptr);
}
/* In the real compile we can copy the string. The starting delimiter is
included so that the client can discover it if they want. We also pass the
start offset to help a script language give better error messages. */
else
{
PCRE2_SPTR pp;
uint32_t delimiter;
uint32_t length = pptr[3];
PCRE2_UCHAR *callout_string = code + (1 + 4*LINK_SIZE);
code[0] = OP_CALLOUT_STR;
PUT(code, 1, pptr[1]); /* Offset to next pattern item */
PUT(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE, pptr[2]); /* Length of next pattern item */
pptr += 3;
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); /* Offset to string in pattern */
pp = cb->start_pattern + offset;
delimiter = *callout_string++ = *pp++;
if (delimiter == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
delimiter = CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
PUT(code, 1 + 3*LINK_SIZE, (int)(offset + 1)); /* One after delimiter */
/* The syntax of the pattern was checked in the parsing scan. The length
includes both delimiters, but we have passed the opening one just above,
so we reduce length before testing it. The test is for > 1 because we do
not want to copy the final delimiter. This also ensures that pp[1] is
accessible. */
while (--length > 1)
{
if (*pp == delimiter && pp[1] == delimiter)
{
*callout_string++ = delimiter;
pp += 2;
length--;
}
else *callout_string++ = *pp++;
}
*callout_string++ = CHAR_NUL;
/* Set the length of the entire item, the advance to its end. */
PUT(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE, (int)(callout_string - code));
code = callout_string;
}
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle repetition. The different types are all sorted out in the parsing
pass. */
case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
case META_MINMAX:
repeat_min = *(++pptr);
repeat_max = *(++pptr);
goto REPEAT;
case META_ASTERISK:
case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
repeat_min = 0;
repeat_max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED;
goto REPEAT;
case META_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_QUERY:
repeat_min = 1;
repeat_max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED;
goto REPEAT;
case META_QUERY:
case META_QUERY_PLUS:
case META_QUERY_QUERY:
repeat_min = 0;
repeat_max = 1;
REPEAT:
if (previous_matched_char && repeat_min > 0) matched_char = TRUE;
/* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat, and default to
single-char opcodes. */
reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY;
op_type = 0;
/* Adjust first and required code units for a zero repeat. */
if (repeat_min == 0)
{
firstcu = zerofirstcu;
firstcuflags = zerofirstcuflags;
reqcu = zeroreqcu;
reqcuflags = zeroreqcuflags;
}
/* Note the greediness and possessiveness. */
switch (meta)
{
case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_PLUS:
case META_QUERY_PLUS:
repeat_type = 0; /* Force greedy */
possessive_quantifier = TRUE;
break;
case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
case META_PLUS_QUERY:
case META_QUERY_QUERY:
repeat_type = greedy_non_default;
possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
break;
default:
repeat_type = greedy_default;
possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
break;
}
/* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to
insert something before it, and remember what it was. */
tempcode = previous;
op_previous = *previous;
/* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. If the repeat
minimum and the repeat maximum are both 1, we can ignore the quantifier for
non-parenthesized items, as they have only one alternative. For anything in
parentheses, we must not ignore if {1} is possessive. */
switch (op_previous)
{
/* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the
item and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of
more than one, ensure that it is set in reqcu - it might not be if a
sequence such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will
have gone into firstcu instead. */
case OP_CHAR:
case OP_CHARI:
case OP_NOT:
case OP_NOTI:
if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
op_type = chartypeoffset[op_previous - OP_CHAR];
/* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one code unit. */
#ifdef MAYBE_UTF_MULTI
if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCU(code[-1]))
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *lastchar = code - 1;
BACKCHAR(lastchar);
mclength = (uint32_t)(code - lastchar); /* Length of UTF character */
memcpy(mcbuffer, lastchar, CU2BYTES(mclength)); /* Save the char */
}
else
#endif /* MAYBE_UTF_MULTI */
/* Handle the case of a single code unit - either with no UTF support, or
with UTF disabled, or for a single-code-unit UTF character. In the latter
case, for a repeated positive match, get the caseless flag for the
required code unit from the previous character, because a class like [Aa]
sets a caseless A but by now the req_caseopt flag has been reset. */
{
mcbuffer[0] = code[-1];
mclength = 1;
if (op_previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1)
{
reqcu = mcbuffer[0];
reqcuflags = cb->req_varyopt;
if (op_previous == OP_CHARI) reqcuflags |= REQ_CASELESS;
}
}
goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT; /* Code shared with single character types */
/* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the
repeat stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
case OP_XCLASS:
#endif
case OP_CLASS:
case OP_NCLASS:
case OP_REF:
case OP_REFI:
case OP_DNREF:
case OP_DNREFI:
if (repeat_max == 0)
{
code = previous;
goto END_REPEAT;
}
if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
*code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type;
else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
*code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type;
else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1)
*code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type;
else
{
*code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type;
PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max = 0; /* 2-byte encoding for max */
PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
}
break;
/* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class []
(PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS is set). The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be
generated, that is by (*FAIL) or (?!), disallow a quantifier at parse
time. We can just ignore this repeat. */
case OP_FAIL:
goto END_REPEAT;
/* Prior to 10.30, repeated recursions were wrapped in OP_ONCE brackets
because pcre2_match() could not handle backtracking into recursively
called groups. Now that this backtracking is available, we no longer need
to do this. However, we still need to replicate recursions as we do for
groups so as to have independent backtracking points. We can replicate
for the minimum number of repeats directly. For optional repeats we now
wrap the recursion in OP_BRA brackets and make use of the bracket
repetition. */
case OP_RECURSE:
if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1 && !possessive_quantifier)
goto END_REPEAT;
/* Generate unwrapped repeats for a non-zero minimum, except when the
minimum is 1 and the maximum unlimited, because that can be handled with
OP_BRA terminated by OP_KETRMAX/MIN. When the maximum is equal to the
minimum, we just need to generate the appropriate additional copies.
Otherwise we need to generate one more, to simulate the situation when
the minimum is zero. */
if (repeat_min > 0 && (repeat_min != 1 || repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED))
{
int replicate = repeat_min;
if (repeat_min == repeat_max) replicate--;
/* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
integer type when available, otherwise double. */
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
PCRE2_SIZE delta = replicate*(1 + LINK_SIZE);
if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)replicate*
(INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(1 + LINK_SIZE) >
(INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20;
return 0;
}
*lengthptr += delta;
}
else for (int i = 0; i < replicate; i++)
{
memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(1 + LINK_SIZE));
previous = code;
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
}
/* If the number of repeats is fixed, we are done. Otherwise, adjust
the counts and fall through. */
if (repeat_min == repeat_max) break;
if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
repeat_min = 0;
}
/* Wrap the recursion call in OP_BRA brackets. */
(void)memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, CU2BYTES(1 + LINK_SIZE));
op_previous = *previous = OP_BRA;
PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET;
PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE;
group_return = -1; /* Set "may match empty string" */
/* Now treat as a repeated OP_BRA. */
/* Fall through */
/* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in
certain cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic"
bracket opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get
converted into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA.
Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does,
for Perl compatibility. */
case OP_ASSERT:
case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
case OP_ASSERT_NA:
case OP_ASSERTBACK:
case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
case OP_ASSERTBACK_NA:
case OP_ONCE:
case OP_SCRIPT_RUN:
case OP_BRA:
case OP_CBRA:
case OP_COND:
{
int len = (int)(code - previous);
PCRE2_UCHAR *bralink = NULL;
PCRE2_UCHAR *brazeroptr = NULL;
if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1 && !possessive_quantifier)
goto END_REPEAT;
/* Repeating a DEFINE group (or any group where the condition is always
FALSE and there is only one branch) is pointless, but Perl allows the
syntax, so we just ignore the repeat. */
if (op_previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_FALSE &&
previous[GET(previous, 1)] != OP_ALT)
goto END_REPEAT;
/* Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when they contain
capturing parentheses and/or are optional there are potential uses for
this feature. PCRE2 used to force the maximum quantifier to 1 on the
invalid grounds that further repetition was never useful. This was
always a bit pointless, since an assertion could be wrapped with a
repeated group to achieve the effect. General repetition is now
permitted, but if the maximum is unlimited it is set to one more than
the minimum. */
if (op_previous < OP_ONCE) /* Assertion */
{
if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max = repeat_min + 1;
}
/* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick
OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the
data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For
this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise
the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the
minimum is zero. */
if (repeat_min == 0)
{
/* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from
the output altogether, like this:
** if (repeat_max == 0)
** {
** code = previous;
** goto END_REPEAT;
** }
However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is
referenced as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we
stick in OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on
execution. As we don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we
cannot do this selectively.
If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the
BRAZERO and do no more at this point. */
if (repeat_max <= 1 || repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
{
(void)memmove(previous + 1, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
code++;
if (repeat_max == 0)
{
*previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO;
goto END_REPEAT;
}
brazeroptr = previous; /* Save for possessive optimizing */
*previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
}
/* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate
in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets.
The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original
copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code
that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to
adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. */
else
{
int linkoffset;
(void)memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
code += 2 + LINK_SIZE;
*previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
*previous++ = OP_BRA;
/* We chain together the bracket link offset fields that have to be
filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */
linkoffset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink);
bralink = previous;
PUTINC(previous, 0, linkoffset);
}
if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max--;
}
/* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many
times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent
copies that we need. */
else
{
if (repeat_min > 1)
{
/* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication.
We just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
integer type when available, otherwise double. */
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
PCRE2_SIZE delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup;
if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)*
(INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup >
(INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20;
return 0;
}
*lengthptr += delta;
}
/* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first code unit
for the group, and we have not yet set a "required code unit", set
it. */
else
{
if (groupsetfirstcu && reqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
{
reqcu = firstcu;
reqcuflags = firstcuflags;
}
for (uint32_t i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++)
{
memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
code += len;
}
}
}
if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
}
/* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If
the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion,
remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero
minimum, the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max
now specifies the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must
remember to replicate entries on the forward reference list. */
if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
{
/* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add
1 to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we
must add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some
paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type
is a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */
if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0)
{
PCRE2_SIZE delta = repeat_max*(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) -
2 - 2*LINK_SIZE; /* Last one doesn't nest */
if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max *
(INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE)
> (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20;
return 0;
}
*lengthptr += delta;
}
/* This is compiling for real */
else for (uint32_t i = repeat_max; i >= 1; i--)
{
*code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
/* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the
chain of brackets outstanding. */
if (i != 1)
{
int linkoffset;
*code++ = OP_BRA;
linkoffset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink);
bralink = code;
PUTINC(code, 0, linkoffset);
}
memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
code += len;
}
/* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length
fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */
while (bralink != NULL)
{
int oldlinkoffset;
int linkoffset = (int)(code - bralink + 1);
PCRE2_UCHAR *bra = code - linkoffset;
oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1);
bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset;
*code++ = OP_KET;
PUTINC(code, 0, linkoffset);
PUT(bra, 1, linkoffset);
}
}
/* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For
SCRIPT_RUN and ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However,
possessively repeated ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing
brackets, as the behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this
saves having to deal with possessive ONCEs specially.
Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see
whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so,
convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so
that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE
and SCRIPT_RUN groups at runtime, but in a different way.]
Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a
conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code
to KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this
kind of subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of
special opcodes makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in
pcre2_match(). If the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to
OP_BRAPOSZERO.
Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive
flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside
atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1,
there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap
the whole thing. */
else
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE;
PCRE2_UCHAR *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1);
/* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */
if (*bracode == OP_ONCE && possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA;
/* For non-possessive ONCE and for SCRIPT_RUN brackets, all we need
to do is to set the KET. */
if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_SCRIPT_RUN)
*ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
/* Handle non-SCRIPT_RUN and non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs
(which have been converted to non-capturing above). */
else
{
/* In the compile phase, adjust the opcode if the group can match
an empty string. For a conditional group with only one branch, the
value of group_return will not show "could be empty", so we must
check that separately. */
if (lengthptr == NULL)
{
if (group_return < 0) *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA;
if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT)
*bracode = OP_SCOND;
}
/* Handle possessive quantifiers. */
if (possessive_quantifier)
{
/* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively
repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS
versions of the COND opcodes. */
if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND)
{
int nlen = (int)(code - bracode);
(void)memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, CU2BYTES(nlen));
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
*bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS;
*code++ = OP_KETRPOS;
PUTINC(code, 0, nlen);
PUT(bracode, 1, nlen);
}
/* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */
else
{
*bracode += 1; /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */
*ketcode = OP_KETRPOS;
}
/* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the
possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */
if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO;
if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
}
/* Non-possessive quantifier */
else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
}
}
}
break;
/* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and
create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character
repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type.
Note the the Unicode property types will be present only when
SUPPORT_UNICODE is defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code
here because it just makes it horribly messy. */
default:
if (op_previous >= OP_EODN) /* Not a character type - internal error */
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR10;
return 0;
}
else
{
int prop_type, prop_value;
PCRE2_UCHAR *oldcode;
if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR; /* Use type opcodes */
mclength = 0; /* Not a character */
if (op_previous == OP_PROP || op_previous == OP_NOTPROP)
{
prop_type = previous[1];
prop_value = previous[2];
}
else
{
/* Come here from just above with a character in mcbuffer/mclength. */
OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT:
prop_type = prop_value = -1;
}
/* At this point, if prop_type == prop_value == -1 we either have a
character in mcbuffer when mclength is greater than zero, or we have
mclength zero, in which case there is a non-property character type in
op_previous. If prop_type/value are not negative, we have a property
character type in op_previous. */
oldcode = code; /* Save where we were */
code = previous; /* Usually overwrite previous item */
/* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows
this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */
if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT;
/* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */
repeat_type += op_type;
/* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as
an UPTO, with the maximum given. */
if (repeat_min == 0)
{
if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
else
{
*code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
}
}
/* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the
maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is
left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with
one less than the maximum. */
else if (repeat_min == 1)
{
if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
*code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type;
else
{
code = oldcode; /* Leave previous item in place */
if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
*code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1);
}
}
/* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is
handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO or STAR or QUERY. */
else
{
*code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type; /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */
PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
/* Unless repeat_max equals repeat_min, fill in the data for EXACT,
and then generate the second opcode. For a repeated Unicode property
match, there are two extra values that define the required property,
and mclength is set zero to indicate this. */
if (repeat_max != repeat_min)
{
if (mclength > 0)
{
memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
code += mclength;
}
else
{
*code++ = op_previous;
if (prop_type >= 0)
{
*code++ = prop_type;
*code++ = prop_value;
}
}
/* Now set up the following opcode */
if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
*code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
else
{
repeat_max -= repeat_min;
if (repeat_max == 1)
{
*code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
}
else
{
*code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
}
}
}
}
/* Fill in the character or character type for the final opcode. */
if (mclength > 0)
{
memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
code += mclength;
}
else
{
*code++ = op_previous;
if (prop_type >= 0)
{
*code++ = prop_type;
*code++ = prop_value;
}
}
}
break;
} /* End of switch on different op_previous values */
/* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is
TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this
case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE
brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from
Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it.
Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been
completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier
is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at
tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose
(former) last char we repeated. */
if (possessive_quantifier)
{
int len;
/* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it.
However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6},
{5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what
remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be
handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */
switch(*tempcode)
{
case OP_TYPEEXACT:
tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] +
((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP
|| tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0);
break;
/* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */
case OP_CHAR:
case OP_CHARI:
case OP_NOT:
case OP_NOTI:
case OP_EXACT:
case OP_EXACTI:
case OP_NOTEXACT:
case OP_NOTEXACTI:
tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode];
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]))
tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]);
#endif
break;
/* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end;
adjust tempcode to point to it. */
case OP_CLASS:
case OP_NCLASS:
tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR);
break;
#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
case OP_XCLASS:
tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1);
break;
#endif
}
/* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated
item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following
QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In
all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will
be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */
len = (int)(code - tempcode);
if (len > 0)
{
unsigned int repcode = *tempcode;
/* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less
than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version.
*/
if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0)
*tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode];
/* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in
ONCE brackets. */
else
{
(void)memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, CU2BYTES(len));
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
*code++ = OP_KET;
PUTINC(code, 0, len);
PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
}
}
}
/* We set the "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered
reqcus if it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length
item. */
END_REPEAT:
cb->req_varyopt |= reqvary;
break;
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle a 32-bit data character with a value greater than META_END. */
case META_BIGVALUE:
pptr++;
goto NORMAL_CHAR;
/* ===============================================================*/
/* Handle a back reference by number, which is the meta argument. The
pattern offsets for back references to group numbers less than 10 are held
in a special vector, to avoid using more than two parsed pattern elements
in 64-bit environments. We only need the offset to the first occurrence,
because if that doesn't fail, subsequent ones will also be OK. */
case META_BACKREF:
if (meta_arg < 10) offset = cb->small_ref_offset[meta_arg];
else GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
if (meta_arg > cb->bracount)
{
cb->erroroffset = offset;
*errorcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */
return 0;
}
/* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a
single group (that is, not to a duplicated name). The back reference
data will have already been updated. We must disable firstcu if not
set, to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set ':'
later. */
HANDLE_SINGLE_REFERENCE:
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
*code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF;
PUT2INC(code, 0, meta_arg);
/* Update the map of back references, and keep the highest one. We
could do this in parse_regex() for numerical back references, but not
for named back references, because we don't know the numbers to which
named back references refer. So we do it all in this function. */
cb->backref_map |= (meta_arg < 32)? (1u << meta_arg) : 1;
if (meta_arg > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = meta_arg;
break;
/* ===============================================================*/
/* Handle recursion by inserting the number of the called group (which is
the meta argument) after OP_RECURSE. At the end of compiling the pattern is
scanned and these numbers are replaced by offsets within the pattern. It is
done like this to avoid problems with forward references and adjusting
offsets when groups are duplicated and moved (as discovered in previous
implementations). Note that a recursion does not have a set first
character. */
case META_RECURSE:
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
if (meta_arg > cb->bracount)
{
cb->erroroffset = offset;
*errorcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */
return 0;
}
HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION:
*code = OP_RECURSE;
PUT(code, 1, meta_arg);
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
groupsetfirstcu = FALSE;
cb->had_recurse = TRUE;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
break;
/* ===============================================================*/
/* Handle capturing parentheses; the number is the meta argument. */
case META_CAPTURE:
bravalue = OP_CBRA;
skipunits = IMM2_SIZE;
PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, meta_arg);
cb->lastcapture = meta_arg;
goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
/* ===============================================================*/
/* Handle escape sequence items. For ones like \d, the ESC_values are
arranged to be the same as the corresponding OP_values in the default case
when PCRE2_UCP is not set (which is the only case in which they will appear
here).
Note: \Q and \E are never seen here, as they were dealt with in
parse_pattern(). Neither are numerical back references or recursions, which
were turned into META_BACKREF or META_RECURSE items, respectively. \k and
\g, when followed by names, are turned into META_BACKREF_BYNAME or
META_RECURSE_BYNAME. */
case META_ESCAPE:
/* We can test for escape sequences that consume a character because their
values lie between ESC_b and ESC_Z; this may have to change if any new ones
are ever created. For these sequences, we disable the setting of a first
character if it hasn't already been set. */
if (meta_arg > ESC_b && meta_arg < ESC_Z)
{
matched_char = TRUE;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
}
/* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
/* If Unicode is not supported, \P and \p are not allowed and are
faulted at parse time, so will never appear here. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (meta_arg == ESC_P || meta_arg == ESC_p)
{
uint32_t ptype = *(++pptr) >> 16;
uint32_t pdata = *pptr & 0xffff;
/* The special case of \p{Any} is compiled to OP_ALLANY so as to benefit
from the auto-anchoring code. */
if (meta_arg == ESC_p && ptype == PT_ANY)
{
*code++ = OP_ALLANY;
}
else
{
*code++ = (meta_arg == ESC_p)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP;
*code++ = ptype;
*code++ = pdata;
}
break; /* End META_ESCAPE */
}
#endif
/* \K is forbidden in lookarounds since 10.38 because that's what Perl has
done. However, there's an option, in case anyone was relying on it. */
if (cb->assert_depth > 0 && meta_arg == ESC_K &&
(cb->cx->extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_LOOKAROUND_BSK) == 0)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR99;
return 0;
}
/* For the rest (including \X when Unicode is supported - if not it's
faulted at parse time), the OP value is the escape value when PCRE2_UCP is
not set; if it is set, these escapes do not show up here because they are
converted into Unicode property tests in parse_regex(). Note that \b and \B
do a one-character lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */
if (meta_arg == ESC_C) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASBKC; /* Record */
if ((meta_arg == ESC_b || meta_arg == ESC_B || meta_arg == ESC_A) &&
cb->max_lookbehind == 0)
cb->max_lookbehind = 1;
/* In non-UTF mode, and for both 32-bit modes, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY
instead of OP_ANYBYTE so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
*code++ = (meta_arg == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : meta_arg;
#else
*code++ = (!utf && meta_arg == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : meta_arg;
#endif
break; /* End META_ESCAPE */
/* ===================================================================*/
/* Handle an unrecognized meta value. A parsed pattern value less than
META_END is a literal. Otherwise we have a problem. */
default:
if (meta >= META_END)
{
#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
fprintf(stderr, "** Unrecognized parsed pattern item 0x%.8x\n", *pptr);
#endif
*errorcodeptr = ERR89; /* Internal error - unrecognized. */
return 0;
}
/* Handle a literal character. We come here by goto in the case of a
32-bit, non-UTF character whose value is greater than META_END. */
NORMAL_CHAR:
meta = *pptr; /* Get the full 32 bits */
NORMAL_CHAR_SET: /* Character is already in meta */
matched_char = TRUE;
/* For caseless UTF or UCP mode, check whether this character has more than
one other case. If so, generate a special OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI.
*/
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((utf||ucp) && (options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)
{
uint32_t caseset = UCD_CASESET(meta);
if (caseset != 0)
{
*code++ = OP_PROP;
*code++ = PT_CLIST;
*code++ = caseset;
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET)
firstcuflags = zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
break; /* End handling this meta item */
}
}
#endif
/* Caseful matches, or caseless and not one of the multicase characters. We
come here by goto in the case of a positive class that contains only
case-partners of a character with just two cases; matched_char has already
been set TRUE and options fudged if necessary. */
CLASS_CASELESS_CHAR:
/* Get the character's code units into mcbuffer, with the length in
mclength. When not in UTF mode, the length is always 1. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if (utf) mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(meta, mcbuffer); else
#endif
{
mclength = 1;
mcbuffer[0] = meta;
}
/* Generate the appropriate code */
*code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR;
memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
code += mclength;
/* Remember if \r or \n were seen */
if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL)
cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF;
/* Set the first and required code units appropriately. If no previous
first code unit, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero
repeat. Otherwise, leave the firstcu value alone, and don't change it on
a zero repeat. */
if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET)
{
zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
/* If the character is more than one code unit long, we can set a single
firstcu only if it is not to be matched caselessly. Multiple possible
starting code units may be picked up later in the studying code. */
if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
{
firstcu = mcbuffer[0];
firstcuflags = req_caseopt;
if (mclength != 1)
{
reqcu = code[-1];
reqcuflags = cb->req_varyopt;
}
}
else firstcuflags = reqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
}
/* firstcu was previously set; we can set reqcu only if the length is
1 or the matching is caseful. */
else
{
zerofirstcu = firstcu;
zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
zeroreqcu = reqcu;
zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
{
reqcu = code[-1];
reqcuflags = req_caseopt | cb->req_varyopt;
}
}
/* If caselessness was temporarily instated, reset it. */
if (reset_caseful)
{
options &= ~PCRE2_CASELESS;
req_caseopt = 0;
reset_caseful = FALSE;
}
break; /* End literal character handling */
} /* End of big switch */
} /* End of big loop */
/* Control never reaches here. */
}
/*************************************************
* Compile regex: a sequence of alternatives *
*************************************************/
/* On entry, pptr is pointing past the bracket meta, but on return it points to
the closing bracket or META_END. The code variable is pointing at the code unit
into which the BRA operator has been stored. This function is used during the
pre-compile phase when we are trying to find out the amount of memory needed,
as well as during the real compile phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes
the two phases.
Arguments:
options option bits, including any changes for this subpattern
codeptr -> the address of the current code pointer
pptrptr -> the address of the current parsed pattern pointer
errorcodeptr -> pointer to error code variable
skipunits skip this many code units at start (for brackets and OP_COND)
firstcuptr place to put the first required code unit
firstcuflagsptr place to put the first code unit flags
reqcuptr place to put the last required code unit
reqcuflagsptr place to put the last required code unit flags
bcptr pointer to the chain of currently open branches
cb points to the data block with tables pointers etc.
lengthptr NULL during the real compile phase
points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
Returns: 0 There has been an error
+1 Success, this group must match at least one character
-1 Success, this group may match an empty string
*/
static int
compile_regex(uint32_t options, PCRE2_UCHAR **codeptr, uint32_t **pptrptr,
int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t skipunits, uint32_t *firstcuptr,
uint32_t *firstcuflagsptr, uint32_t *reqcuptr, uint32_t *reqcuflagsptr,
branch_chain *bcptr, compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SIZE *lengthptr)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *code = *codeptr;
PCRE2_UCHAR *last_branch = code;
PCRE2_UCHAR *start_bracket = code;
BOOL lookbehind;
open_capitem capitem;
int capnumber = 0;
int okreturn = 1;
uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr;
uint32_t firstcu, reqcu;
uint32_t lookbehindlength;
uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags;
uint32_t branchfirstcu, branchreqcu;
uint32_t branchfirstcuflags, branchreqcuflags;
PCRE2_SIZE length;
branch_chain bc;
/* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */
if (cb->cx->stack_guard != NULL &&
cb->cx->stack_guard(cb->parens_depth, cb->cx->stack_guard_data))
{
*errorcodeptr= ERR33;
return 0;
}
/* Miscellaneous initialization */
bc.outer = bcptr;
bc.current_branch = code;
firstcu = reqcu = 0;
firstcuflags = reqcuflags = REQ_UNSET;
/* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the
length of the BRA and KET and any extra code units that are required at the
beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of
lengthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of 'code' at the
start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during
the pre-compile phase so that the workspace is not exceeded. */
length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipunits;
/* Remember if this is a lookbehind assertion, and if it is, save its length
and skip over the pattern offset. */
lookbehind = *code == OP_ASSERTBACK ||
*code == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT ||
*code == OP_ASSERTBACK_NA;
if (lookbehind)
{
lookbehindlength = META_DATA(pptr[-1]);
pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
}
else lookbehindlength = 0;
/* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items
so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. Note that only OP_CBRA
need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants, e.g.
OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */
if (*code == OP_CBRA)
{
capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
capitem.number = capnumber;
capitem.next = cb->open_caps;
capitem.assert_depth = cb->assert_depth;
cb->open_caps = &capitem;
}
/* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */
PUT(code, 1, 0);
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipunits;
/* Loop for each alternative branch */
for (;;)
{
int branch_return;
/* Insert OP_REVERSE if this is as lookbehind assertion. */
if (lookbehind && lookbehindlength > 0)
{
*code++ = OP_REVERSE;
PUTINC(code, 0, lookbehindlength);
length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
}
/* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added
into the length. */
if ((branch_return =
compile_branch(&options, &code, &pptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstcu,
&branchfirstcuflags, &branchreqcu, &branchreqcuflags, &bc,
cb, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length)) == 0)
return 0;
/* If a branch can match an empty string, so can the whole group. */
if (branch_return < 0) okreturn = -1;
/* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */
if (lengthptr == NULL)
{
/* If this is the first branch, the firstcu and reqcu values for the
branch become the values for the regex. */
if (*last_branch != OP_ALT)
{
firstcu = branchfirstcu;
firstcuflags = branchfirstcuflags;
reqcu = branchreqcu;
reqcuflags = branchreqcuflags;
}
/* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqcu have to
match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the
previous value for reqcu didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match,
and we set REQ_VARY for the group from this branch's value. */
else
{
/* If we previously had a firstcu, but it doesn't match the new branch,
we have to abandon the firstcu for the regex, but if there was
previously no reqcu, it takes on the value of the old firstcu. */
if (firstcuflags != branchfirstcuflags || firstcu != branchfirstcu)
{
if (firstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
{
if (reqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
{
reqcu = firstcu;
reqcuflags = firstcuflags;
}
}
firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
}
/* If we (now or from before) have no firstcu, a firstcu from the
branch becomes a reqcu if there isn't a branch reqcu. */
if (firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE && branchfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE &&
branchreqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
{
branchreqcu = branchfirstcu;
branchreqcuflags = branchfirstcuflags;
}
/* Now ensure that the reqcus match */
if (((reqcuflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcuflags & ~REQ_VARY)) ||
reqcu != branchreqcu)
reqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
else
{
reqcu = branchreqcu;
reqcuflags |= branchreqcuflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY if present */
}
}
}
/* Handle reaching the end of the expression, either ')' or end of pattern.
In the real compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and
reverse the chain of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an
offset to the first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to
the end of the group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length
of the whole bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating
char. */
if (META_CODE(*pptr) != META_ALT)
{
if (lengthptr == NULL)
{
PCRE2_SIZE branch_length = code - last_branch;
do
{
PCRE2_SIZE prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1);
PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length);
branch_length = prev_length;
last_branch -= branch_length;
}
while (branch_length > 0);
}
/* Fill in the ket */
*code = OP_KET;
PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
/* If it was a capturing subpattern, remove the block from the chain. */
if (capnumber > 0) cb->open_caps = cb->open_caps->next;
/* Set values to pass back */
*codeptr = code;
*pptrptr = pptr;
*firstcuptr = firstcu;
*firstcuflagsptr = firstcuflags;
*reqcuptr = reqcu;
*reqcuflagsptr = reqcuflags;
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length)
{
*errorcodeptr = ERR20;
return 0;
}
*lengthptr += length;
}
return okreturn;
}
/* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code
pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is,
pretend that each branch is the only one.)
In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back
to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain
is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a
zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */
if (lengthptr != NULL)
{
code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipunits;
length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
}
else
{
*code = OP_ALT;
PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch));
bc.current_branch = last_branch = code;
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
}
/* Set the lookbehind length (if not in a lookbehind the value will be zero)
and then advance past the vertical bar. */
lookbehindlength = META_DATA(*pptr);
pptr++;
}
/* Control never reaches here */
}
/*************************************************
* Check for anchored pattern *
*************************************************/
/* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each
alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket
all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then
it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will
be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode.
We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches.
This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking
into account the match offset".
A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set,
because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points,
so there is no point trying again.... er ....
.... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a
subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information
to catch that case precisely.
At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets
and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level.
However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some
of the more common cases more precisely.
... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because
this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted.
Arguments:
code points to start of the compiled pattern
bracket_map a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
the less precise approach
cb points to the compile data block
atomcount atomic group level
inassert TRUE if in an assertion
Returns: TRUE or FALSE
*/
static BOOL
is_anchored(PCRE2_SPTR code, uint32_t bracket_map, compile_block *cb,
int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
{
do {
PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(
code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
int op = *scode;
/* Non-capturing brackets */
if (op == OP_BRA || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
{
if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert))
return FALSE;
}
/* Capturing brackets */
else if (op == OP_CBRA || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
{
int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
uint32_t new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1u << n) : 1);
if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
}
/* Positive forward assertion */
else if (op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)
{
if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
}
/* Condition. If there is no second branch, it can't be anchored. */
else if (op == OP_COND || op == OP_SCOND)
{
if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE;
if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert))
return FALSE;
}
/* Atomic groups */
else if (op == OP_ONCE)
{
if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount + 1, inassert))
return FALSE;
}
/* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and
it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic
group or an assertion. Also the pattern must not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP,
because these break the feature. Consider, for example, /(?s).*?(*PRUNE)b/
with the subject "aab", which matches "b", i.e. not at the start of a line.
There is also an option that disables auto-anchoring. */
else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR ||
op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR))
{
if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cb->backref_map) != 0 ||
atomcount > 0 || cb->had_pruneorskip || inassert ||
(cb->external_options & PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR) != 0)
return FALSE;
}
/* Check for explicit anchoring */
else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE;
code += GET(code, 1);
}
while (*code == OP_ALT); /* Loop for each alternative */
return TRUE;
}
/*************************************************
* Check for starting with ^ or .* *
*************************************************/
/* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that
"first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline
matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at
the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we
have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .*
because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .*
inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE
or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds.
Arguments:
code points to start of the compiled pattern or a group
bracket_map a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
the less precise approach
cb points to the compile data
atomcount atomic group level
inassert TRUE if in an assertion
Returns: TRUE or FALSE
*/
static BOOL
is_startline(PCRE2_SPTR code, unsigned int bracket_map, compile_block *cb,
int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
{
do {
PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(
code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
int op = *scode;
/* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the
conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test
for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an
auto-callout at the start of a condition. */
if (op == OP_COND)
{
scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
else if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT_STR) scode += GET(scode, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
switch (*scode)
{
case OP_CREF:
case OP_DNCREF:
case OP_RREF:
case OP_DNRREF:
case OP_FAIL:
case OP_FALSE:
case OP_TRUE:
return FALSE;
default: /* Assertion */
if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT);
scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
break;
}
scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE);
op = *scode;
}
/* Non-capturing brackets */
if (op == OP_BRA || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
{
if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert))
return FALSE;
}
/* Capturing brackets */
else if (op == OP_CBRA || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
{
int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
unsigned int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1u << n) : 1);
if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
}
/* Positive forward assertions */
else if (op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)
{
if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE))
return FALSE;
}
/* Atomic brackets */
else if (op == OP_ONCE)
{
if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount + 1, inassert))
return FALSE;
}
/* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or
brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, and as long as the pattern
does not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider,
for example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab",
i.e. not at the start of a line. There is also an option that disables this
optimization. */
else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)
{
if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cb->backref_map) != 0 ||
atomcount > 0 || cb->had_pruneorskip || inassert ||
(cb->external_options & PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR) != 0)
return FALSE;
}
/* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note
in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE because the number
of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside them. */
else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE;
/* Move on to the next alternative */
code += GET(code, 1);
}
while (*code == OP_ALT); /* Loop for each alternative */
return TRUE;
}
/*************************************************
* Scan compiled regex for recursion reference *
*************************************************/
/* This function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an instance of
OP_RECURSE.
Arguments:
code points to start of expression
utf TRUE in UTF mode
Returns: pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found
*/
static PCRE2_SPTR
find_recurse(PCRE2_SPTR code, BOOL utf)
{
for (;;)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR c = *code;
if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code;
/* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit map.
This includes negated single high-valued characters. CALLOUT_STR is used for
callouts with string arguments. In both cases the length in the table is
zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
else if (c == OP_CALLOUT_STR) code += GET(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
/* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
two code units of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument,
we must add in its length. */
else
{
switch(c)
{
case OP_TYPESTAR:
case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
case OP_TYPEPLUS:
case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
case OP_TYPEQUERY:
case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
break;
case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
case OP_TYPEUPTO:
case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
case OP_TYPEEXACT:
if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
code += 2;
break;
case OP_MARK:
case OP_COMMIT_ARG:
case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
case OP_SKIP_ARG:
case OP_THEN_ARG:
code += code[1];
break;
}
/* Add in the fixed length from the table */
code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
/* In UTF-8 and UTF-16 modes, opcodes that are followed by a character may
be followed by a multi-unit character. The length in the table is a
minimum, so we have to arrange to skip the extra units. */
#ifdef MAYBE_UTF_MULTI
if (utf) switch(c)
{
case OP_CHAR:
case OP_CHARI:
case OP_NOT:
case OP_NOTI:
case OP_EXACT:
case OP_EXACTI:
case OP_NOTEXACT:
case OP_NOTEXACTI:
case OP_UPTO:
case OP_UPTOI:
case OP_NOTUPTO:
case OP_NOTUPTOI:
case OP_MINUPTO:
case OP_MINUPTOI:
case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
case OP_POSUPTO:
case OP_POSUPTOI:
case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
case OP_STAR:
case OP_STARI:
case OP_NOTSTAR:
case OP_NOTSTARI:
case OP_MINSTAR:
case OP_MINSTARI:
case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
case OP_POSSTAR:
case OP_POSSTARI:
case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
case OP_PLUS:
case OP_PLUSI:
case OP_NOTPLUS:
case OP_NOTPLUSI:
case OP_MINPLUS:
case OP_MINPLUSI:
case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
case OP_POSPLUS:
case OP_POSPLUSI:
case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
case OP_QUERY:
case OP_QUERYI:
case OP_NOTQUERY:
case OP_NOTQUERYI:
case OP_MINQUERY:
case OP_MINQUERYI:
case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
case OP_POSQUERY:
case OP_POSQUERYI:
case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
break;
}
#else
(void)(utf); /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
#endif /* MAYBE_UTF_MULTI */
}
}
}
/*************************************************
* Check for asserted fixed first code unit *
*************************************************/
/* During compilation, the "first code unit" settings from forward assertions
are discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that
follow. However, if we end up without a first code unit setting for an
unanchored pattern, it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an
initial asserted first code unit. If all branches start with the same asserted
code unit, or with a non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start
with the same asserted code unit (recurse ad lib), then we return that code
unit, with the flags set to zero or REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with
REQ_NONE in the flags.
Arguments:
code points to start of compiled pattern
flags points to the first code unit flags
inassert non-zero if in an assertion
Returns: the fixed first code unit, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags
*/
static uint32_t
find_firstassertedcu(PCRE2_SPTR code, uint32_t *flags, uint32_t inassert)
{
uint32_t c = 0;
uint32_t cflags = REQ_NONE;
*flags = REQ_NONE;
do {
uint32_t d;
uint32_t dflags;
int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA ||
*code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0;
PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl, TRUE);
PCRE2_UCHAR op = *scode;
switch(op)
{
default:
return 0;
case OP_BRA:
case OP_BRAPOS:
case OP_CBRA:
case OP_SCBRA:
case OP_CBRAPOS:
case OP_SCBRAPOS:
case OP_ASSERT:
case OP_ASSERT_NA:
case OP_ONCE:
case OP_SCRIPT_RUN:
d = find_firstassertedcu(scode, &dflags, inassert +
((op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)?1:0));
if (dflags >= REQ_NONE) return 0;
if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = d; cflags = dflags; }
else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0;
break;
case OP_EXACT:
scode += IMM2_SIZE;
/* Fall through */
case OP_CHAR:
case OP_PLUS:
case OP_MINPLUS:
case OP_POSPLUS:
if (inassert == 0) return 0;
if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; }
else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
break;
case OP_EXACTI:
scode += IMM2_SIZE;
/* Fall through */
case OP_CHARI:
case OP_PLUSI:
case OP_MINPLUSI:
case OP_POSPLUSI:
if (inassert == 0) return 0;
/* If the character is more than one code unit long, we cannot set its
first code unit when matching caselessly. Later scanning may pick up
multiple code units. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
if (scode[1] >= 0x80) return 0;
#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
if (scode[1] >= 0xd800 && scode[1] <= 0xdfff) return 0;
#endif
#endif
if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; }
else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
break;
}
code += GET(code, 1);
}
while (*code == OP_ALT);
*flags = cflags;
return c;
}
/*************************************************
* Add an entry to the name/number table *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the
name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted
and forbidden duplicates has already been done.
Arguments:
cb the compile data block
name the name to add
length the length of the name
groupno the group number
tablecount the count of names in the table so far
Returns: nothing
*/
static void
add_name_to_table(compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SPTR name, int length,
unsigned int groupno, uint32_t tablecount)
{
uint32_t i;
PCRE2_UCHAR *slot = cb->name_table;
for (i = 0; i < tablecount; i++)
{
int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, CU2BYTES(length));
if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0)
crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */
/* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a
duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the
simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all
cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */
if (crc < 0)
{
(void)memmove(slot + cb->name_entry_size, slot,
CU2BYTES((tablecount - i) * cb->name_entry_size));
break;
}
/* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */
slot += cb->name_entry_size;
}
PUT2(slot, 0, groupno);
memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, CU2BYTES(length));
/* Add a terminating zero and fill the rest of the slot with zeroes so that
the memory is all initialized. Otherwise valgrind moans about uninitialized
memory when saving serialized compiled patterns. */
memset(slot + IMM2_SIZE + length, 0,
CU2BYTES(cb->name_entry_size - length - IMM2_SIZE));
}
/*************************************************
* Skip in parsed pattern *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called to skip parts of the parsed pattern when finding the
length of a lookbehind branch. It is called after (*ACCEPT) and (*FAIL) to find
the end of the branch, it is called to skip over an internal lookaround or
(DEFINE) group, and it is also called to skip to the end of a class, during
which it will never encounter nested groups (but there's no need to have
special code for that).
When called to find the end of a branch or group, pptr must point to the first
meta code inside the branch, not the branch-starting code. In other cases it
can point to the item that causes the function to be called.
Arguments:
pptr current pointer to skip from
skiptype PSKIP_CLASS when skipping to end of class
PSKIP_ALT when META_ALT ends the skip
PSKIP_KET when only META_KET ends the skip
Returns: new value of pptr
NULL if META_END is reached - should never occur
or for an unknown meta value - likewise
*/
static uint32_t *
parsed_skip(uint32_t *pptr, uint32_t skiptype)
{
uint32_t nestlevel = 0;
for (;; pptr++)
{
uint32_t meta = META_CODE(*pptr);
switch(meta)
{
default: /* Just skip over most items */
if (meta < META_END) continue; /* Literal */
break;
/* This should never occur. */
case META_END:
return NULL;
/* The data for these items is variable in length. */
case META_BACKREF: /* Offset is present only if group >= 10 */
if (META_DATA(*pptr) >= 10) pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
break;
case META_ESCAPE: /* A few escapes are followed by data items. */
switch (META_DATA(*pptr))
{
case ESC_P:
case ESC_p:
pptr += 1;
break;
case ESC_g:
case ESC_k:
pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET;
break;
}
break;
case META_MARK: /* Add the length of the name. */
case META_COMMIT_ARG:
case META_PRUNE_ARG:
case META_SKIP_ARG:
case META_THEN_ARG:
pptr += pptr[1];
break;
/* These are the "active" items in this loop. */
case META_CLASS_END:
if (skiptype == PSKIP_CLASS) return pptr;
break;
case META_ATOMIC:
case META_CAPTURE:
case META_COND_ASSERT:
case META_COND_DEFINE:
case META_COND_NAME:
case META_COND_NUMBER:
case META_COND_RNAME:
case META_COND_RNUMBER:
case META_COND_VERSION:
case META_LOOKAHEAD:
case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
case META_LOOKBEHIND:
case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
case META_NOCAPTURE:
case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
nestlevel++;
break;
case META_ALT:
if (nestlevel == 0 && skiptype == PSKIP_ALT) return pptr;
break;
case META_KET:
if (nestlevel == 0) return pptr;
nestlevel--;
break;
}
/* The extra data item length for each meta is in a table. */
meta = (meta >> 16) & 0x7fff;
if (meta >= sizeof(meta_extra_lengths)) return NULL;
pptr += meta_extra_lengths[meta];
}
/* Control never reaches here */
return pptr;
}
/*************************************************
* Find length of a parsed group *
*************************************************/
/* This is called for nested groups within a branch of a lookbehind whose
length is being computed. If all the branches in the nested group have the same
length, that is OK. On entry, the pointer must be at the first element after
the group initializing code. On exit it points to OP_KET. Caching is used to
improve processing speed when the same capturing group occurs many times.
Arguments:
pptrptr pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern
isinline FALSE if a reference or recursion; TRUE for inline group
errcodeptr pointer to the errorcode
lcptr pointer to the loop counter
group number of captured group or -1 for a non-capturing group
recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
cb pointer to the compile data
Returns: the group length or a negative number
*/
static int
get_grouplength(uint32_t **pptrptr, BOOL isinline, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr,
int group, parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb)
{
int branchlength;
int grouplength = -1;
/* The cache can be used only if there is no possibility of there being two
groups with the same number. We do not need to set the end pointer for a group
that is being processed as a back reference or recursion, but we must do so for
an inline group. */
if (group > 0 && (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) == 0)
{
uint32_t groupinfo = cb->groupinfo[group];
if ((groupinfo & GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH) != 0) return -1;
if ((groupinfo & GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH) != 0)
{
if (isinline) *pptrptr = parsed_skip(*pptrptr, PSKIP_KET);
return groupinfo & GI_FIXED_LENGTH_MASK;
}
}
/* Scan the group. In this case we find the end pointer of necessity. */
for(;;)
{
branchlength = get_branchlength(pptrptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb);
if (branchlength < 0) goto ISNOTFIXED;
if (grouplength == -1) grouplength = branchlength;
else if (grouplength != branchlength) goto ISNOTFIXED;
if (**pptrptr == META_KET) break;
*pptrptr += 1; /* Skip META_ALT */
}
if (group > 0)
cb->groupinfo[group] |= (uint32_t)(GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH | grouplength);
return grouplength;
ISNOTFIXED:
if (group > 0) cb->groupinfo[group] |= GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH;
return -1;
}
/*************************************************
* Find length of a parsed branch *
*************************************************/
/* Return a fixed length for a branch in a lookbehind, giving an error if the
length is not fixed. On entry, *pptrptr points to the first element inside the
branch. On exit it is set to point to the ALT or KET.
Arguments:
pptrptr pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern
errcodeptr pointer to error code
lcptr pointer to loop counter
recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
cb pointer to compile block
Returns: the length, or a negative value on error
*/
static int
get_branchlength(uint32_t **pptrptr, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr,
parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb)
{
int branchlength = 0;
int grouplength;
uint32_t lastitemlength = 0;
uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr;
PCRE2_SIZE offset;
parsed_recurse_check this_recurse;
/* A large and/or complex regex can take too long to process. This can happen
more often when (?| groups are present in the pattern because their length
cannot be cached. */
if ((*lcptr)++ > 2000)
{
*errcodeptr = ERR35; /* Lookbehind is too complicated */
return -1;
}
/* Scan the branch, accumulating the length. */
for (;; pptr++)
{
parsed_recurse_check *r;
uint32_t *gptr, *gptrend;
uint32_t escape;
uint32_t group = 0;
uint32_t itemlength = 0;
if (*pptr < META_END)
{
itemlength = 1;
}
else switch (META_CODE(*pptr))
{
case META_KET:
case META_ALT:
goto EXIT;
/* (*ACCEPT) and (*FAIL) terminate the branch, but we must skip to the
actual termination. */
case META_ACCEPT:
case META_FAIL:
pptr = parsed_skip(pptr, PSKIP_ALT);
if (pptr == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED;
goto EXIT;
case META_MARK:
case META_COMMIT_ARG:
case META_PRUNE_ARG:
case META_SKIP_ARG:
case META_THEN_ARG:
pptr += pptr[1] + 1;
break;
case META_CIRCUMFLEX:
case META_COMMIT:
case META_DOLLAR:
case META_PRUNE:
case META_SKIP:
case META_THEN:
break;
case META_OPTIONS:
pptr += 1;
break;
case META_BIGVALUE:
itemlength = 1;
pptr += 1;
break;
case META_CLASS:
case META_CLASS_NOT:
itemlength = 1;
pptr = parsed_skip(pptr, PSKIP_CLASS);
if (pptr == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED;
break;
case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT:
case META_DOT:
itemlength = 1;
break;
case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
pptr += 3;
break;
case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
pptr += 3 + SIZEOFFSET;
break;
/* Only some escapes consume a character. Of those, \R and \X are never
allowed because they might match more than character. \C is allowed only in
32-bit and non-UTF 8/16-bit modes. */
case META_ESCAPE:
escape = META_DATA(*pptr);
if (escape == ESC_R || escape == ESC_X) return -1;
if (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)
{
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH != 32
if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0 && escape == ESC_C)
{
*errcodeptr = ERR36;
return -1;
}
#endif
itemlength = 1;
if (escape == ESC_p || escape == ESC_P) pptr++; /* Skip prop data */
}
break;
/* Lookaheads do not contribute to the length of this branch, but they may
contain lookbehinds within them whose lengths need to be set. */
case META_LOOKAHEAD:
case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
*errcodeptr = check_lookbehinds(pptr + 1, &pptr, recurses, cb, lcptr);
if (*errcodeptr != 0) return -1;
/* Ignore any qualifiers that follow a lookahead assertion. */
switch (pptr[1])
{
case META_ASTERISK:
case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
case META_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_QUERY:
case META_QUERY:
case META_QUERY_PLUS:
case META_QUERY_QUERY:
pptr++;
break;
case META_MINMAX:
case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
pptr += 3;
break;
default:
break;
}
break;
/* A nested lookbehind does not contribute any length to this lookbehind,
but must itself be checked and have its lengths set. */
case META_LOOKBEHIND:
case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
if (!set_lookbehind_lengths(&pptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb))
return -1;
break;
/* Back references and recursions are handled by very similar code. At this
stage, the names generated in the parsing pass are available, but the main
name table has not yet been created. So for the named varieties, scan the
list of names in order to get the number of the first one in the pattern,
and whether or not this name is duplicated. */
case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF) != 0)
goto ISNOTFIXED;
/* Fall through */
case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
{
int i;
PCRE2_SPTR name;
BOOL is_dupname = FALSE;
named_group *ng = cb->named_groups;
uint32_t meta_code = META_CODE(*pptr);
uint32_t length = *(++pptr);
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
name = cb->start_pattern + offset;
for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
{
if (length == ng->length && PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0)
{
group = ng->number;
is_dupname = ng->isdup;
break;
}
}
if (group == 0)
{
*errcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */
cb->erroroffset = offset;
return -1;
}
/* A numerical back reference can be fixed length if duplicate capturing
groups are not being used. A non-duplicate named back reference can also
be handled. */
if (meta_code == META_RECURSE_BYNAME ||
(!is_dupname && (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) == 0))
goto RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH; /* Handle as a numbered version. */
}
goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Duplicate name or number */
/* The offset values for back references < 10 are in a separate vector
because otherwise they would use more than two parsed pattern elements on
64-bit systems. */
case META_BACKREF:
if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF) != 0 ||
(cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) != 0)
goto ISNOTFIXED;
group = META_DATA(*pptr);
if (group < 10)
{
offset = cb->small_ref_offset[group];
goto RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH;
}
/* Fall through */
/* For groups >= 10 - picking up group twice does no harm. */
/* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may
be OK. Back reference "recursions" are also failed. */
case META_RECURSE:
group = META_DATA(*pptr);
GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH:
if (group > cb->bracount)
{
cb->erroroffset = offset;
*errcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */
return -1;
}
if (group == 0) goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Local recursion */
for (gptr = cb->parsed_pattern; *gptr != META_END; gptr++)
{
if (META_CODE(*gptr) == META_BIGVALUE) gptr++;
else if (*gptr == (META_CAPTURE | group)) break;
}
/* We must start the search for the end of the group at the first meta code
inside the group. Otherwise it will be treated as an enclosed group. */
gptrend = parsed_skip(gptr + 1, PSKIP_KET);
if (gptrend == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED;
if (pptr > gptr && pptr < gptrend) goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Local recursion */
for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->groupptr == gptr) break;
if (r != NULL) goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Mutual recursion */
this_recurse.prev = recurses;
this_recurse.groupptr = gptr;
/* We do not need to know the position of the end of the group, that is,
gptr is not used after the call to get_grouplength(). Setting the second
argument FALSE stops it scanning for the end when the length can be found
in the cache. */
gptr++;
grouplength = get_grouplength(&gptr, FALSE, errcodeptr, lcptr, group,
&this_recurse, cb);
if (grouplength < 0)
{
if (*errcodeptr == 0) goto ISNOTFIXED;
return -1; /* Error already set */
}
itemlength = grouplength;
break;
/* A (DEFINE) group is never obeyed inline and so it does not contribute to
the length of this branch. Skip from the following item to the next
unpaired ket. */
case META_COND_DEFINE:
pptr = parsed_skip(pptr + 1, PSKIP_KET);
break;
/* Check other nested groups - advance past the initial data for each type
and then seek a fixed length with get_grouplength(). */
case META_COND_NAME:
case META_COND_NUMBER:
case META_COND_RNAME:
case META_COND_RNUMBER:
pptr += 2 + SIZEOFFSET;
goto CHECK_GROUP;
case META_COND_ASSERT:
pptr += 1;
goto CHECK_GROUP;
case META_COND_VERSION:
pptr += 4;
goto CHECK_GROUP;
case META_CAPTURE:
group = META_DATA(*pptr);
/* Fall through */
case META_ATOMIC:
case META_NOCAPTURE:
case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
pptr++;
CHECK_GROUP:
grouplength = get_grouplength(&pptr, TRUE, errcodeptr, lcptr, group,
recurses, cb);
if (grouplength < 0) return -1;
itemlength = grouplength;
break;
/* Exact repetition is OK; variable repetition is not. A repetition of zero
must subtract the length that has already been added. */
case META_MINMAX:
case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
if (pptr[1] == pptr[2])
{
switch(pptr[1])
{
case 0:
branchlength -= lastitemlength;
break;
case 1:
itemlength = 0;
break;
default: /* Check for integer overflow */
if (lastitemlength != 0 && /* Should not occur, but just in case */
INT_MAX/lastitemlength < pptr[1] - 1)
{
*errcodeptr = ERR87; /* Integer overflow; lookbehind too big */
return -1;
}
itemlength = (pptr[1] - 1) * lastitemlength;
break;
}
pptr += 2;
break;
}
/* Fall through */
/* Any other item means this branch does not have a fixed length. */
default:
ISNOTFIXED:
*errcodeptr = ERR25; /* Not fixed length */
return -1;
}
/* Add the item length to the branchlength, checking for integer overflow and
for the branch length exceeding the limit. */
if (INT_MAX - branchlength < (int)itemlength ||
(branchlength += itemlength) > LOOKBEHIND_MAX)
{
*errcodeptr = ERR87;
return -1;
}
/* Save this item length for use if the next item is a quantifier. */
lastitemlength = itemlength;
}
EXIT:
*pptrptr = pptr;
return branchlength;
PARSED_SKIP_FAILED:
*errcodeptr = ERR90;
return -1;
}
/*************************************************
* Set lengths in a lookbehind *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called for each lookbehind, to set the lengths in its
branches. An error occurs if any branch does not have a fixed length that is
less than the maximum (65535). On exit, the pointer must be left on the final
ket.
The function also maintains the max_lookbehind value. Any lookbehind branch
that contains a nested lookbehind may actually look further back than the
length of the branch. The additional amount is passed back from
get_branchlength() as an "extra" value.
Arguments:
pptrptr pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern
errcodeptr pointer to error code
lcptr pointer to loop counter
recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
cb pointer to compile block
Returns: TRUE if all is well
FALSE otherwise, with error code and offset set
*/
static BOOL
set_lookbehind_lengths(uint32_t **pptrptr, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr,
parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb)
{
PCRE2_SIZE offset;
int branchlength;
uint32_t *bptr = *pptrptr;
READPLUSOFFSET(offset, bptr); /* Offset for error messages */
*pptrptr += SIZEOFFSET;
do
{
*pptrptr += 1;
branchlength = get_branchlength(pptrptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb);
if (branchlength < 0)
{
/* The errorcode and offset may already be set from a nested lookbehind. */
if (*errcodeptr == 0) *errcodeptr = ERR25;
if (cb->erroroffset == PCRE2_UNSET) cb->erroroffset = offset;
return FALSE;
}
if (branchlength > cb->max_lookbehind) cb->max_lookbehind = branchlength;
*bptr |= branchlength; /* branchlength never more than 65535 */
bptr = *pptrptr;
}
while (*bptr == META_ALT);
return TRUE;
}
/*************************************************
* Check parsed pattern lookbehinds *
*************************************************/
/* This function is called at the end of parsing a pattern if any lookbehinds
were encountered. It scans the parsed pattern for them, calling
set_lookbehind_lengths() for each one. At the start, the errorcode is zero and
the error offset is marked unset. The enables the functions above not to
override settings from deeper nestings.
This function is called recursively from get_branchlength() for lookaheads in
order to process any lookbehinds that they may contain. It stops when it hits a
non-nested closing parenthesis in this case, returning a pointer to it.
Arguments
pptr points to where to start (start of pattern or start of lookahead)
retptr if not NULL, return the ket pointer here
recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
cb points to the compile block
lcptr points to loop counter
Returns: 0 on success, or an errorcode (cb->erroroffset will be set)
*/
static int
check_lookbehinds(uint32_t *pptr, uint32_t **retptr,
parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb, int *lcptr)
{
int errorcode = 0;
int nestlevel = 0;
cb->erroroffset = PCRE2_UNSET;
for (; *pptr != META_END; pptr++)
{
if (*pptr < META_END) continue; /* Literal */
switch (META_CODE(*pptr))
{
default:
return ERR70; /* Unrecognized meta code */
case META_ESCAPE:
if (*pptr - META_ESCAPE == ESC_P || *pptr - META_ESCAPE == ESC_p)
pptr += 1;
break;
case META_KET:
if (--nestlevel < 0)
{
if (retptr != NULL) *retptr = pptr;
return 0;
}
break;
case META_ATOMIC:
case META_CAPTURE:
case META_COND_ASSERT:
case META_LOOKAHEAD:
case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
case META_NOCAPTURE:
case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
nestlevel++;
break;
case META_ACCEPT:
case META_ALT:
case META_ASTERISK:
case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
case META_BACKREF:
case META_CIRCUMFLEX:
case META_CLASS:
case META_CLASS_EMPTY:
case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT:
case META_CLASS_END:
case META_CLASS_NOT:
case META_COMMIT:
case META_DOLLAR:
case META_DOT:
case META_FAIL:
case META_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_PLUS:
case META_PLUS_QUERY:
case META_PRUNE:
case META_QUERY:
case META_QUERY_PLUS:
case META_QUERY_QUERY:
case META_RANGE_ESCAPED:
case META_RANGE_LITERAL:
case META_SKIP:
case META_THEN:
break;
case META_RECURSE:
pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
break;
case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET;
break;
case META_COND_DEFINE:
pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
nestlevel++;
break;
case META_COND_NAME:
case META_COND_NUMBER:
case META_COND_RNAME:
case META_COND_RNUMBER:
pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET;
nestlevel++;
break;
case META_COND_VERSION:
pptr += 3;
nestlevel++;
break;
case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
pptr += 3 + SIZEOFFSET;
break;
case META_BIGVALUE:
case META_OPTIONS:
case META_POSIX:
case META_POSIX_NEG:
pptr += 1;
break;
case META_MINMAX:
case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
pptr += 2;
break;
case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
pptr += 3;
break;
case META_MARK:
case META_COMMIT_ARG:
case META_PRUNE_ARG:
case META_SKIP_ARG:
case META_THEN_ARG:
pptr += 1 + pptr[1];
break;
case META_LOOKBEHIND:
case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
if (!set_lookbehind_lengths(&pptr, &errorcode, lcptr, recurses, cb))
return errorcode;
break;
}
}
return 0;
}
/*************************************************
* External function to compile a pattern *
*************************************************/
/* This function reads a regular expression in the form of a string and returns
a pointer to a block of store holding a compiled version of the expression.
Arguments:
pattern the regular expression
patlen the length of the pattern, or PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED
options option bits
errorptr pointer to errorcode
erroroffset pointer to error offset
ccontext points to a compile context or is NULL
Returns: pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error,
with errorcode and erroroffset set
*/
PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
pcre2_compile(PCRE2_SPTR pattern, PCRE2_SIZE patlen, uint32_t options,
int *errorptr, PCRE2_SIZE *erroroffset, pcre2_compile_context *ccontext)
{
BOOL utf; /* Set TRUE for UTF mode */
BOOL ucp; /* Set TRUE for UCP mode */
BOOL has_lookbehind = FALSE; /* Set TRUE if a lookbehind is found */
BOOL zero_terminated; /* Set TRUE for zero-terminated pattern */
pcre2_real_code *re = NULL; /* What we will return */
compile_block cb; /* "Static" compile-time data */
const uint8_t *tables; /* Char tables base pointer */
PCRE2_UCHAR *code; /* Current pointer in compiled code */
PCRE2_SPTR codestart; /* Start of compiled code */
PCRE2_SPTR ptr; /* Current pointer in pattern */
uint32_t *pptr; /* Current pointer in parsed pattern */
PCRE2_SIZE length = 1; /* Allow for final END opcode */
PCRE2_SIZE usedlength; /* Actual length used */
PCRE2_SIZE re_blocksize; /* Size of memory block */
PCRE2_SIZE big32count = 0; /* 32-bit literals >= 0x80000000 */
PCRE2_SIZE parsed_size_needed; /* Needed for parsed pattern */
uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags; /* Type of first/req code unit */
uint32_t firstcu, reqcu; /* Value of first/req code unit */
uint32_t setflags = 0; /* NL and BSR set flags */
uint32_t skipatstart; /* When checking (*UTF) etc */
uint32_t limit_heap = UINT32_MAX;
uint32_t limit_match = UINT32_MAX; /* Unset match limits */
uint32_t limit_depth = UINT32_MAX;
int newline = 0; /* Unset; can be set by the pattern */
int bsr = 0; /* Unset; can be set by the pattern */
int errorcode = 0; /* Initialize to avoid compiler warn */
int regexrc; /* Return from compile */
uint32_t i; /* Local loop counter */
/* Comments at the head of this file explain about these variables. */
uint32_t stack_groupinfo[GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE];
uint32_t stack_parsed_pattern[PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE];
named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE];
/* The workspace is used in different ways in the different compiling phases.
It needs to be 16-bit aligned for the preliminary parsing scan. */
uint32_t c16workspace[C16_WORK_SIZE];
PCRE2_UCHAR *cworkspace = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)c16workspace;
/* -------------- Check arguments and set up the pattern ----------------- */
/* There must be error code and offset pointers. */
if (errorptr == NULL || erroroffset == NULL) return NULL;
*errorptr = ERR0;
*erroroffset = 0;
/* There must be a pattern! */
if (pattern == NULL)
{
*errorptr = ERR16;
return NULL;
}
/* A NULL compile context means "use a default context" */
if (ccontext == NULL)
ccontext = (pcre2_compile_context *)(&PRIV(default_compile_context));
/* PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF implies UTF */
if ((options & PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF) != 0) options |= PCRE2_UTF;
/* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero. */
if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0 ||
(ccontext->extra_options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS) != 0)
{
*errorptr = ERR17;
return NULL;
}
if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) != 0 &&
((options & ~PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0 ||
(ccontext->extra_options & ~PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS) != 0))
{
*errorptr = ERR92;
return NULL;
}
/* A zero-terminated pattern is indicated by the special length value
PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED. Check for an overlong pattern. */
if ((zero_terminated = (patlen == PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED)))
patlen = PRIV(strlen)(pattern);
if (patlen > ccontext->max_pattern_length)
{
*errorptr = ERR88;
return NULL;
}
/* From here on, all returns from this function should end up going via the
EXIT label. */
/* ------------ Initialize the "static" compile data -------------- */
tables = (ccontext->tables != NULL)? ccontext->tables : PRIV(default_tables);
cb.lcc = tables + lcc_offset; /* Individual */
cb.fcc = tables + fcc_offset; /* character */
cb.cbits = tables + cbits_offset; /* tables */
cb.ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset;
cb.assert_depth = 0;
cb.bracount = 0;
cb.cx = ccontext;
cb.dupnames = FALSE;
cb.end_pattern = pattern + patlen;
cb.erroroffset = 0;
cb.external_flags = 0;
cb.external_options = options;
cb.groupinfo = stack_groupinfo;
cb.had_recurse = FALSE;
cb.lastcapture = 0;
cb.max_lookbehind = 0;
cb.name_entry_size = 0;
cb.name_table = NULL;
cb.named_groups = named_groups;
cb.named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE;
cb.names_found = 0;
cb.open_caps = NULL;
cb.parens_depth = 0;
cb.parsed_pattern = stack_parsed_pattern;
cb.req_varyopt = 0;
cb.start_code = cworkspace;
cb.start_pattern = pattern;
cb.start_workspace = cworkspace;
cb.workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE;
/* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back
references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not.
*/
cb.top_backref = 0;
cb.backref_map = 0;
/* Escape sequences \1 to \9 are always back references, but as they are only
two characters long, only two elements can be used in the parsed_pattern
vector. The first contains the reference, and we'd like to use the second to
record the offset in the pattern, so that forward references to non-existent
groups can be diagnosed later with an offset. However, on 64-bit systems,
PCRE2_SIZE won't fit. Instead, we have a vector of offsets for the first
occurrence of \1 to \9, indexed by the second parsed_pattern value. All other
references have enough space for the offset to be put into the parsed pattern.
*/
for (i = 0; i < 10; i++) cb.small_ref_offset[i] = PCRE2_UNSET;
/* --------------- Start looking at the pattern --------------- */
/* Unless PCRE2_LITERAL is set, check for global one-time option settings at
the start of the pattern, and remember the offset to the actual regex. With
valgrind support, make the terminator of a zero-terminated pattern
inaccessible. This catches bugs that would otherwise only show up for
non-zero-terminated patterns. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
if (zero_terminated) VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(pattern + patlen, CU2BYTES(1));
#endif
ptr = pattern;
skipatstart = 0;
if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) == 0)
{
while (patlen - skipatstart >= 2 &&
ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS &&
ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK)
{
for (i = 0; i < sizeof(pso_list)/sizeof(pso); i++)
{
uint32_t c, pp;
pso *p = pso_list + i;
if (patlen - skipatstart - 2 >= p->length &&
PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr + skipatstart + 2, (char *)(p->name),
p->length) == 0)
{
skipatstart += p->length + 2;
switch(p->type)
{
case PSO_OPT:
cb.external_options |= p->value;
break;
case PSO_FLG:
setflags |= p->value;
break;
case PSO_NL:
newline = p->value;
setflags |= PCRE2_NL_SET;
break;
case PSO_BSR:
bsr = p->value;
setflags |= PCRE2_BSR_SET;
break;
case PSO_LIMM:
case PSO_LIMD:
case PSO_LIMH:
c = 0;
pp = skipatstart;
if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[pp]))
{
errorcode = ERR60;
ptr += pp;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[pp]))
{
if (c > UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break; /* Integer overflow */
c = c*10 + (ptr[pp++] - CHAR_0);
}
if (ptr[pp++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
{
errorcode = ERR60;
ptr += pp;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
if (p->type == PSO_LIMH) limit_heap = c;
else if (p->type == PSO_LIMM) limit_match = c;
else limit_depth = c;
skipatstart += pp - skipatstart;
break;
}
break; /* Out of the table scan loop */
}
}
if (i >= sizeof(pso_list)/sizeof(pso)) break; /* Out of pso loop */
}
}
/* End of pattern-start options; advance to start of real regex. */
ptr += skipatstart;
/* Can't support UTF or UCP if PCRE2 was built without Unicode support. */
#ifndef SUPPORT_UNICODE
if ((cb.external_options & (PCRE2_UTF|PCRE2_UCP)) != 0)
{
errorcode = ERR32;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
#endif
/* Check UTF. We have the original options in 'options', with that value as
modified by (*UTF) etc in cb->external_options. The extra option
PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES is not permitted in UTF-16 mode because the
surrogate code points cannot be represented in UTF-16. */
utf = (cb.external_options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
if (utf)
{
if ((options & PCRE2_NEVER_UTF) != 0)
{
errorcode = ERR74;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
if ((options & PCRE2_NO_UTF_CHECK) == 0 &&
(errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)(pattern, patlen, erroroffset)) != 0)
goto HAD_ERROR; /* Offset was set by valid_utf() */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
if ((ccontext->extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) != 0)
{
errorcode = ERR91;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
#endif
}
/* Check UCP lockout. */
ucp = (cb.external_options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0;
if (ucp && (cb.external_options & PCRE2_NEVER_UCP) != 0)
{
errorcode = ERR75;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
/* Process the BSR setting. */
if (bsr == 0) bsr = ccontext->bsr_convention;
/* Process the newline setting. */
if (newline == 0) newline = ccontext->newline_convention;
cb.nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED;
switch(newline)
{
case PCRE2_NEWLINE_CR:
cb.nllen = 1;
cb.nl[0] = CHAR_CR;
break;
case PCRE2_NEWLINE_LF:
cb.nllen = 1;
cb.nl[0] = CHAR_NL;
break;
case PCRE2_NEWLINE_NUL:
cb.nllen = 1;
cb.nl[0] = CHAR_NUL;
break;
case PCRE2_NEWLINE_CRLF:
cb.nllen = 2;
cb.nl[0] = CHAR_CR;
cb.nl[1] = CHAR_NL;
break;
case PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANY:
cb.nltype = NLTYPE_ANY;
break;
case PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF:
cb.nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF;
break;
default:
errorcode = ERR56;
goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
}
/* Pre-scan the pattern to do two things: (1) Discover the named groups and
their numerical equivalents, so that this information is always available for
the remaining processing. (2) At the same time, parse the pattern and put a
processed version into the parsed_pattern vector. This has escapes interpreted
and comments removed (amongst other things).
In all but one case, when PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT is not set, the number of unsigned
32-bit ints in the parsed pattern is bounded by the length of the pattern plus
one (for the terminator) plus four if PCRE2_EXTRA_WORD or PCRE2_EXTRA_LINE is
set. The exceptional case is when running in 32-bit, non-UTF mode, when literal
characters greater than META_END (0x80000000) have to be coded as two units. In
this case, therefore, we scan the pattern to check for such values. */
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
if (!utf)
{
PCRE2_SPTR p;
for (p = ptr; p < cb.end_pattern; p++) if (*p >= META_END) big32count++;
}
#endif
/* Ensure that the parsed pattern buffer is big enough. When PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT
is set we have to assume a numerical callout (4 elements) for each character
plus one at the end. This is overkill, but memory is plentiful these days. For
many smaller patterns the vector on the stack (which was set up above) can be
used. */
parsed_size_needed = patlen - skipatstart + big32count;
if ((ccontext->extra_options &
(PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD|PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE)) != 0)
parsed_size_needed += 4;
if ((options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0)
parsed_size_needed = (parsed_size_needed + 1) * 5;
if (parsed_size_needed >= PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE)
{
uint32_t *heap_parsed_pattern = ccontext->memctl.malloc(
(parsed_size_needed + 1) * sizeof(uint32_t), ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
if (heap_parsed_pattern == NULL)
{
*errorptr = ERR21;
goto EXIT;
}
cb.parsed_pattern = heap_parsed_pattern;
}
cb.parsed_pattern_end = cb.parsed_pattern + parsed_size_needed + 1;
/* Do the parsing scan. */
errorcode = parse_regex(ptr, cb.external_options, &has_lookbehind, &cb);
if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
/* Workspace is needed to remember information about numbered groups: whether a
group can match an empty string and what its fixed length is. This is done to
avoid the possibility of recursive references causing very long compile times
when checking these features. Unnumbered groups do not have this exposure since
they cannot be referenced. We use an indexed vector for this purpose. If there
are sufficiently few groups, the default vector on the stack, as set up above,
can be used. Otherwise we have to get/free a special vector. The vector must be
initialized to zero. */
if (cb.bracount >= GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE)
{
cb.groupinfo = ccontext->memctl.malloc(
(cb.bracount + 1)*sizeof(uint32_t), ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
if (cb.groupinfo == NULL)
{
errorcode = ERR21;
cb.erroroffset = 0;
goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
}
}
memset(cb.groupinfo, 0, (cb.bracount + 1) * sizeof(uint32_t));
/* If there were any lookbehinds, scan the parsed pattern to figure out their
lengths. */
if (has_lookbehind)
{
int loopcount = 0;
errorcode = check_lookbehinds(cb.parsed_pattern, NULL, NULL, &cb, &loopcount);
if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
}
/* For debugging, there is a function that shows the parsed data vector. */
#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
fprintf(stderr, "+++ Pre-scan complete:\n");
show_parsed(&cb);
#endif
/* For debugging capturing information this code can be enabled. */
#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_CAPTURES
{
named_group *ng = cb.named_groups;
fprintf(stderr, "+++Captures: %d\n", cb.bracount);
for (i = 0; i < cb.names_found; i++, ng++)
{
fprintf(stderr, "+++%3d %.*s\n", ng->number, ng->length, ng->name);
}
}
#endif
/* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the amount
of memory required in the 'length' variable. This behaviour is triggered by
passing a non-NULL final argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of
workspace (cworkspace) for it to compile parts of the pattern into; the
compiled code is discarded when it is no longer needed, so hopefully this
workspace will never overflow, though there is a test for its doing so.
On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the
result of the function. The initial options have been put into the cb block,
but we still have to pass a separate options variable (the first argument)
because the options may change as the pattern is processed. */
cb.erroroffset = patlen; /* For any subsequent errors that do not set it */
pptr = cb.parsed_pattern;
code = cworkspace;
*code = OP_BRA;
(void)compile_regex(cb.external_options, &code, &pptr, &errorcode, 0, &firstcu,
&firstcuflags, &reqcu, &reqcuflags, NULL, &cb, &length);
if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR; /* Offset is in cb.erroroffset */
/* This should be caught in compile_regex(), but just in case... */
if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
{
errorcode = ERR20;
goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
}
/* Compute the size of, and then get and initialize, the data block for storing
the compiled pattern and names table. Integer overflow should no longer be
possible because nowadays we limit the maximum value of cb.names_found and
cb.name_entry_size. */
re_blocksize = sizeof(pcre2_real_code) +
CU2BYTES(length +
(PCRE2_SIZE)cb.names_found * (PCRE2_SIZE)cb.name_entry_size);
re = (pcre2_real_code *)
ccontext->memctl.malloc(re_blocksize, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
if (re == NULL)
{
errorcode = ERR21;
goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
}
/* The compiler may put padding at the end of the pcre2_real_code structure in
order to round it up to a multiple of 4 or 8 bytes. This means that when a
compiled pattern is copied (for example, when serialized) undefined bytes are
read, and this annoys debuggers such as valgrind. To avoid this, we explicitly
write to the last 8 bytes of the structure before setting the fields. */
memset((char *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code) - 8, 0, 8);
re->memctl = ccontext->memctl;
re->tables = tables;
re->executable_jit = NULL;
memset(re->start_bitmap, 0, 32 * sizeof(uint8_t));
re->blocksize = re_blocksize;
re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER;
re->compile_options = options;
re->overall_options = cb.external_options;
re->extra_options = ccontext->extra_options;
re->flags = PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH/8 | cb.external_flags | setflags;
re->limit_heap = limit_heap;
re->limit_match = limit_match;
re->limit_depth = limit_depth;
re->first_codeunit = 0;
re->last_codeunit = 0;
re->bsr_convention = bsr;
re->newline_convention = newline;
re->max_lookbehind = 0;
re->minlength = 0;
re->top_bracket = 0;
re->top_backref = 0;
re->name_entry_size = cb.name_entry_size;
re->name_count = cb.names_found;
/* The basic block is immediately followed by the name table, and the compiled
code follows after that. */
codestart = (PCRE2_SPTR)((uint8_t *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code)) +
re->name_entry_size * re->name_count;
/* Update the compile data block for the actual compile. The starting points of
the name/number translation table and of the code are passed around in the
compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial options are already set
from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size field. */
cb.parens_depth = 0;
cb.assert_depth = 0;
cb.lastcapture = 0;
cb.name_table = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)((uint8_t *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code));
cb.start_code = codestart;
cb.req_varyopt = 0;
cb.had_accept = FALSE;
cb.had_pruneorskip = FALSE;
cb.open_caps = NULL;
/* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list
created in the pre-pass. */
if (cb.names_found > 0)
{
named_group *ng = cb.named_groups;
for (i = 0; i < cb.names_found; i++, ng++)
add_name_to_table(&cb, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number, i);
}
/* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On
error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result
of the function here. */
pptr = cb.parsed_pattern;
code = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart;
*code = OP_BRA;
regexrc = compile_regex(re->overall_options, &code, &pptr, &errorcode, 0,
&firstcu, &firstcuflags, &reqcu, &reqcuflags, NULL, &cb, NULL);
if (regexrc < 0) re->flags |= PCRE2_MATCH_EMPTY;
re->top_bracket = cb.bracount;
re->top_backref = cb.top_backref;
re->max_lookbehind = cb.max_lookbehind;
if (cb.had_accept)
{
reqcu = 0; /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */
reqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
re->flags |= PCRE2_HASACCEPT; /* Disables minimum length */
}
/* Fill in the final opcode and check for disastrous overflow. If no overflow,
but the estimated length exceeds the really used length, adjust the value of
re->blocksize, and if valgrind support is configured, mark the extra allocated
memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be detected. */
*code++ = OP_END;
usedlength = code - codestart;
if (usedlength > length) errorcode = ERR23; else
{
re->blocksize -= CU2BYTES(length - usedlength);
#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, CU2BYTES(length - usedlength));
#endif
}
/* Scan the pattern for recursion/subroutine calls and convert the group
numbers into offsets. Maintain a small cache so that repeated groups containing
recursions are efficiently handled. */
#define RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE 8
if (errorcode == 0 && cb.had_recurse)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *rcode;
PCRE2_SPTR rgroup;
unsigned int ccount = 0;
int start = RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE;
recurse_cache rc[RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE];
for (rcode = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)find_recurse(codestart, utf);
rcode != NULL;
rcode = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)find_recurse(rcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf))
{
int p, groupnumber;
groupnumber = (int)GET(rcode, 1);
if (groupnumber == 0) rgroup = codestart; else
{
PCRE2_SPTR search_from = codestart;
rgroup = NULL;
for (i = 0, p = start; i < ccount; i++, p = (p + 1) & 7)
{
if (groupnumber == rc[p].groupnumber)
{
rgroup = rc[p].group;
break;
}
/* Group n+1 must always start to the right of group n, so we can save
search time below when the new group number is greater than any of the
previously found groups. */
if (groupnumber > rc[p].groupnumber) search_from = rc[p].group;
}
if (rgroup == NULL)
{
rgroup = PRIV(find_bracket)(search_from, utf, groupnumber);
if (rgroup == NULL)
{
errorcode = ERR53;
break;
}
if (--start < 0) start = RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE - 1;
rc[start].groupnumber = groupnumber;
rc[start].group = rgroup;
if (ccount < RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE) ccount++;
}
}
PUT(rcode, 1, rgroup - codestart);
}
}
/* In rare debugging situations we sometimes need to look at the compiled code
at this stage. */
#ifdef DEBUG_CALL_PRINTINT
pcre2_printint(re, stderr, TRUE);
fprintf(stderr, "Length=%lu Used=%lu\n", length, usedlength);
#endif
/* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be
auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so
the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is
used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of
"const" attribute if the cast (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart is used directly in the
function call. */
if (errorcode == 0 && (re->overall_options & PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0)
{
PCRE2_UCHAR *temp = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart;
if (PRIV(auto_possessify)(temp, &cb) != 0) errorcode = ERR80;
}
/* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing. */
if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
/* Successful compile. If the anchored option was not passed, set it if
we can determine that the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A
or anything else, such as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and
there are no occurrences of *PRUNE or *SKIP (though there is an option to
disable this case). */
if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 &&
is_anchored(codestart, 0, &cb, 0, FALSE))
re->overall_options |= PCRE2_ANCHORED;
/* Set up the first code unit or startline flag, the required code unit, and
then study the pattern. This code need not be obeyed if PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE
is set, as the data it would create will not be used. Note that a first code
unit (but not the startline flag) is useful for anchored patterns because it
can still give a quick "no match" and also avoid searching for a last code
unit. */
if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE) == 0)
{
int minminlength = 0; /* For minimal minlength from first/required CU */
/* If we do not have a first code unit, see if there is one that is asserted
(these are not saved during the compile because they can cause conflicts with
actual literals that follow). */
if (firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
firstcu = find_firstassertedcu(codestart, &firstcuflags, 0);
/* Save the data for a first code unit. The existence of one means the
minimum length must be at least 1. */
if (firstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
{
re->first_codeunit = firstcu;
re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTSET;
minminlength++;
/* Handle caseless first code units. */
if ((firstcuflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
{
if (firstcu < 128 || (!utf && !ucp && firstcu < 255))
{
if (cb.fcc[firstcu] != firstcu) re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS;
}
/* The first code unit is > 128 in UTF or UCP mode, or > 255 otherwise.
In 8-bit UTF mode, codepoints in the range 128-255 are introductory code
points and cannot have another case, but if UCP is set they may do. */
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
else if (ucp && !utf && UCD_OTHERCASE(firstcu) != firstcu)
re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS;
#else
else if ((utf || ucp) && firstcu <= MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT &&
UCD_OTHERCASE(firstcu) != firstcu)
re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS;
#endif
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
}
}
/* When there is no first code unit, for non-anchored patterns, see if we can
set the PCRE2_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all
branches start with ^ and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for
non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. (There is an option
that disables this case.) */
else if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 &&
is_startline(codestart, 0, &cb, 0, FALSE))
re->flags |= PCRE2_STARTLINE;
/* Handle the "required code unit", if one is set. In the UTF case we can
increment the minimum minimum length only if we are sure this really is a
different character and not a non-starting code unit of the first character,
because the minimum length count is in characters, not code units. */
if (reqcuflags < REQ_NONE)
{
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 || /* Not UTF */
firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE || /* First not set */
(firstcu & 0xf800) != 0xd800 || /* First not surrogate */
(reqcu & 0xfc00) != 0xdc00) /* Req not low surrogate */
#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 || /* Not UTF */
firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE || /* First not set */
(firstcu & 0x80) == 0 || /* First is ASCII */
(reqcu & 0x80) == 0) /* Req is ASCII */
#endif
{
minminlength++;
}
/* In the case of an anchored pattern, set up the value only if it follows
a variable length item in the pattern. */
if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 ||
(reqcuflags & REQ_VARY) != 0)
{
re->last_codeunit = reqcu;
re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTSET;
/* Handle caseless required code units as for first code units (above). */
if ((reqcuflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
{
if (reqcu < 128 || (!utf && !ucp && reqcu < 255))
{
if (cb.fcc[reqcu] != reqcu) re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS;
}
#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
else if (ucp && !utf && UCD_OTHERCASE(reqcu) != reqcu)
re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS;
#else
else if ((utf || ucp) && reqcu <= MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT &&
UCD_OTHERCASE(reqcu) != reqcu)
re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS;
#endif
#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
}
}
}
/* Study the compiled pattern to set up information such as a bitmap of
starting code units and a minimum matching length. */
if (PRIV(study)(re) != 0)
{
errorcode = ERR31;
goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
}
/* If study() set a bitmap of starting code units, it implies a minimum
length of at least one. */
if ((re->flags & PCRE2_FIRSTMAPSET) != 0 && minminlength == 0)
minminlength = 1;
/* If the minimum length set (or not set) by study() is less than the minimum
implied by required code units, override it. */
if (re->minlength < minminlength) re->minlength = minminlength;
} /* End of start-of-match optimizations. */
/* Control ends up here in all cases. When running under valgrind, make a
pattern's terminating zero defined again. If memory was obtained for the parsed
version of the pattern, free it before returning. Also free the list of named
groups if a larger one had to be obtained, and likewise the group information
vector. */
EXIT:
#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
if (zero_terminated) VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_DEFINED(pattern + patlen, CU2BYTES(1));
#endif
if (cb.parsed_pattern != stack_parsed_pattern)
ccontext->memctl.free(cb.parsed_pattern, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
if (cb.named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
ccontext->memctl.free((void *)cb.named_groups, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
if (cb.groupinfo != stack_groupinfo)
ccontext->memctl.free((void *)cb.groupinfo, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
return re; /* Will be NULL after an error */
/* Errors discovered in parse_regex() set the offset value in the compile
block. Errors discovered before it is called must compute it from the ptr
value. After parse_regex() is called, the offset in the compile block is set to
the end of the pattern, but certain errors in compile_regex() may reset it if
an offset is available in the parsed pattern. */
HAD_CB_ERROR:
ptr = pattern + cb.erroroffset;
HAD_EARLY_ERROR:
*erroroffset = ptr - pattern;
HAD_ERROR:
*errorptr = errorcode;
pcre2_code_free(re);
re = NULL;
goto EXIT;
}
/* These #undefs are here to enable unity builds with CMake. */
#undef NLBLOCK /* Block containing newline information */
#undef PSSTART /* Field containing processed string start */
#undef PSEND /* Field containing processed string end */
/* End of pcre2_compile.c */